PostgreSQL Source Code git master
Loading...
Searching...
No Matches
xlog.c
Go to the documentation of this file.
1/*-------------------------------------------------------------------------
2 *
3 * xlog.c
4 * PostgreSQL write-ahead log manager
5 *
6 * The Write-Ahead Log (WAL) functionality is split into several source
7 * files, in addition to this one:
8 *
9 * xloginsert.c - Functions for constructing WAL records
10 * xlogrecovery.c - WAL recovery and standby code
11 * xlogreader.c - Facility for reading WAL files and parsing WAL records
12 * xlogutils.c - Helper functions for WAL redo routines
13 *
14 * This file contains functions for coordinating database startup and
15 * checkpointing, and managing the write-ahead log buffers when the
16 * system is running.
17 *
18 * StartupXLOG() is the main entry point of the startup process. It
19 * coordinates database startup, performing WAL recovery, and the
20 * transition from WAL recovery into normal operations.
21 *
22 * XLogInsertRecord() inserts a WAL record into the WAL buffers. Most
23 * callers should not call this directly, but use the functions in
24 * xloginsert.c to construct the WAL record. XLogFlush() can be used
25 * to force the WAL to disk.
26 *
27 * In addition to those, there are many other functions for interrogating
28 * the current system state, and for starting/stopping backups.
29 *
30 *
31 * Portions Copyright (c) 1996-2026, PostgreSQL Global Development Group
32 * Portions Copyright (c) 1994, Regents of the University of California
33 *
34 * src/backend/access/transam/xlog.c
35 *
36 *-------------------------------------------------------------------------
37 */
38
39#include "postgres.h"
40
41#include <ctype.h>
42#include <math.h>
43#include <time.h>
44#include <fcntl.h>
45#include <sys/stat.h>
46#include <sys/time.h>
47#include <unistd.h>
48
49#include "access/clog.h"
50#include "access/commit_ts.h"
51#include "access/heaptoast.h"
52#include "access/multixact.h"
53#include "access/rewriteheap.h"
54#include "access/subtrans.h"
55#include "access/timeline.h"
56#include "access/transam.h"
57#include "access/twophase.h"
58#include "access/xact.h"
60#include "access/xlogarchive.h"
61#include "access/xloginsert.h"
62#include "access/xlogreader.h"
63#include "access/xlogrecovery.h"
64#include "access/xlogutils.h"
65#include "access/xlogwait.h"
66#include "backup/basebackup.h"
67#include "catalog/catversion.h"
68#include "catalog/pg_control.h"
69#include "catalog/pg_database.h"
71#include "common/file_utils.h"
72#include "executor/instrument.h"
73#include "miscadmin.h"
74#include "pg_trace.h"
75#include "pgstat.h"
76#include "port/atomics.h"
77#include "postmaster/bgwriter.h"
79#include "postmaster/startup.h"
82#include "replication/origin.h"
83#include "replication/slot.h"
88#include "storage/bufmgr.h"
89#include "storage/fd.h"
90#include "storage/ipc.h"
92#include "storage/latch.h"
93#include "storage/predicate.h"
94#include "storage/proc.h"
95#include "storage/procarray.h"
96#include "storage/procsignal.h"
97#include "storage/reinit.h"
98#include "storage/spin.h"
99#include "storage/subsystems.h"
100#include "storage/sync.h"
101#include "utils/guc_hooks.h"
102#include "utils/guc_tables.h"
105#include "utils/ps_status.h"
106#include "utils/relmapper.h"
107#include "utils/snapmgr.h"
108#include "utils/timeout.h"
109#include "utils/timestamp.h"
110#include "utils/varlena.h"
111#include "utils/wait_event.h"
112
113#ifdef WAL_DEBUG
114#include "utils/memutils.h"
115#endif
116
117/* timeline ID to be used when bootstrapping */
118#define BootstrapTimeLineID 1
119
120/* User-settable parameters */
121int max_wal_size_mb = 1024; /* 1 GB */
122int min_wal_size_mb = 80; /* 80 MB */
124int XLOGbuffers = -1;
128bool EnableHotStandby = false;
129bool fullPageWrites = true;
130bool wal_log_hints = false;
134bool wal_init_zero = true;
135bool wal_recycle = true;
136bool log_checkpoints = true;
139int CommitDelay = 0; /* precommit delay in microseconds */
140int CommitSiblings = 5; /* # concurrent xacts needed to sleep */
143int wal_decode_buffer_size = 512 * 1024;
145
146#ifdef WAL_DEBUG
147bool XLOG_DEBUG = false;
148#endif
149
151
152/*
153 * Number of WAL insertion locks to use. A higher value allows more insertions
154 * to happen concurrently, but adds some CPU overhead to flushing the WAL,
155 * which needs to iterate all the locks.
156 */
157#define NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS 8
158
159/*
160 * Max distance from last checkpoint, before triggering a new xlog-based
161 * checkpoint.
162 */
164
165/* Estimated distance between checkpoints, in bytes */
167static double PrevCheckPointDistance = 0;
168
169/*
170 * Track whether there were any deferred checks for custom resource managers
171 * specified in wal_consistency_checking.
172 */
174
175/*
176 * GUC support
177 */
179 {"fsync", WAL_SYNC_METHOD_FSYNC, false},
180#ifdef HAVE_FSYNC_WRITETHROUGH
181 {"fsync_writethrough", WAL_SYNC_METHOD_FSYNC_WRITETHROUGH, false},
182#endif
183 {"fdatasync", WAL_SYNC_METHOD_FDATASYNC, false},
184#ifdef O_SYNC
185 {"open_sync", WAL_SYNC_METHOD_OPEN, false},
186#endif
187#ifdef O_DSYNC
188 {"open_datasync", WAL_SYNC_METHOD_OPEN_DSYNC, false},
189#endif
190 {NULL, 0, false}
191};
192
193
194/*
195 * Although only "on", "off", and "always" are documented,
196 * we accept all the likely variants of "on" and "off".
197 */
199 {"always", ARCHIVE_MODE_ALWAYS, false},
200 {"on", ARCHIVE_MODE_ON, false},
201 {"off", ARCHIVE_MODE_OFF, false},
202 {"true", ARCHIVE_MODE_ON, true},
203 {"false", ARCHIVE_MODE_OFF, true},
204 {"yes", ARCHIVE_MODE_ON, true},
205 {"no", ARCHIVE_MODE_OFF, true},
206 {"1", ARCHIVE_MODE_ON, true},
207 {"0", ARCHIVE_MODE_OFF, true},
208 {NULL, 0, false}
209};
210
211/*
212 * Statistics for current checkpoint are collected in this global struct.
213 * Because only the checkpointer or a stand-alone backend can perform
214 * checkpoints, this will be unused in normal backends.
215 */
217
218/*
219 * During recovery, lastFullPageWrites keeps track of full_page_writes that
220 * the replayed WAL records indicate. It's initialized with full_page_writes
221 * that the recovery starting checkpoint record indicates, and then updated
222 * each time XLOG_FPW_CHANGE record is replayed.
223 */
225
226/*
227 * Local copy of the state tracked by SharedRecoveryState in shared memory,
228 * It is false if SharedRecoveryState is RECOVERY_STATE_DONE. True actually
229 * means "not known, need to check the shared state".
230 */
231static bool LocalRecoveryInProgress = true;
232
233/*
234 * Local state for XLogInsertAllowed():
235 * 1: unconditionally allowed to insert XLOG
236 * 0: unconditionally not allowed to insert XLOG
237 * -1: must check RecoveryInProgress(); disallow until it is false
238 * Most processes start with -1 and transition to 1 after seeing that recovery
239 * is not in progress. But we can also force the value for special cases.
240 * The coding in XLogInsertAllowed() depends on the first two of these states
241 * being numerically the same as bool true and false.
242 */
244
245/*
246 * ProcLastRecPtr points to the start of the last XLOG record inserted by the
247 * current backend. It is updated for all inserts. XactLastRecEnd points to
248 * end+1 of the last record, and is reset when we end a top-level transaction,
249 * or start a new one; so it can be used to tell if the current transaction has
250 * created any XLOG records.
251 *
252 * While in parallel mode, this may not be fully up to date. When committing,
253 * a transaction can assume this covers all xlog records written either by the
254 * user backend or by any parallel worker which was present at any point during
255 * the transaction. But when aborting, or when still in parallel mode, other
256 * parallel backends may have written WAL records at later LSNs than the value
257 * stored here. The parallel leader advances its own copy, when necessary,
258 * in WaitForParallelWorkersToFinish.
259 */
263
264/*
265 * RedoRecPtr is this backend's local copy of the REDO record pointer
266 * (which is almost but not quite the same as a pointer to the most recent
267 * CHECKPOINT record). We update this from the shared-memory copy,
268 * XLogCtl->Insert.RedoRecPtr, whenever we can safely do so (ie, when we
269 * hold an insertion lock). See XLogInsertRecord for details. We are also
270 * allowed to update from XLogCtl->RedoRecPtr if we hold the info_lck;
271 * see GetRedoRecPtr.
272 *
273 * NB: Code that uses this variable must be prepared not only for the
274 * possibility that it may be arbitrarily out of date, but also for the
275 * possibility that it might be set to InvalidXLogRecPtr. We used to
276 * initialize it as a side effect of the first call to RecoveryInProgress(),
277 * which meant that most code that might use it could assume that it had a
278 * real if perhaps stale value. That's no longer the case.
279 */
281
282/*
283 * doPageWrites is this backend's local copy of (fullPageWrites ||
284 * runningBackups > 0). It is used together with RedoRecPtr to decide whether
285 * a full-page image of a page need to be taken.
286 *
287 * NB: Initially this is false, and there's no guarantee that it will be
288 * initialized to any other value before it is first used. Any code that
289 * makes use of it must recheck the value after obtaining a WALInsertLock,
290 * and respond appropriately if it turns out that the previous value wasn't
291 * accurate.
292 */
293static bool doPageWrites;
294
295/*----------
296 * Shared-memory data structures for XLOG control
297 *
298 * LogwrtRqst indicates a byte position that we need to write and/or fsync
299 * the log up to (all records before that point must be written or fsynced).
300 * The positions already written/fsynced are maintained in logWriteResult
301 * and logFlushResult using atomic access.
302 * In addition to the shared variable, each backend has a private copy of
303 * both in LogwrtResult, which is updated when convenient.
304 *
305 * The request bookkeeping is simpler: there is a shared XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst
306 * (protected by info_lck), but we don't need to cache any copies of it.
307 *
308 * info_lck is only held long enough to read/update the protected variables,
309 * so it's a plain spinlock. The other locks are held longer (potentially
310 * over I/O operations), so we use LWLocks for them. These locks are:
311 *
312 * WALBufMappingLock: must be held to replace a page in the WAL buffer cache.
313 * It is only held while initializing and changing the mapping. If the
314 * contents of the buffer being replaced haven't been written yet, the mapping
315 * lock is released while the write is done, and reacquired afterwards.
316 *
317 * WALWriteLock: must be held to write WAL buffers to disk (XLogWrite or
318 * XLogFlush).
319 *
320 * ControlFileLock: must be held to read/update control file or create
321 * new log file.
322 *
323 *----------
324 */
325
326typedef struct XLogwrtRqst
327{
328 XLogRecPtr Write; /* last byte + 1 to write out */
329 XLogRecPtr Flush; /* last byte + 1 to flush */
331
332typedef struct XLogwrtResult
333{
334 XLogRecPtr Write; /* last byte + 1 written out */
335 XLogRecPtr Flush; /* last byte + 1 flushed */
337
338/*
339 * Inserting to WAL is protected by a small fixed number of WAL insertion
340 * locks. To insert to the WAL, you must hold one of the locks - it doesn't
341 * matter which one. To lock out other concurrent insertions, you must hold
342 * of them. Each WAL insertion lock consists of a lightweight lock, plus an
343 * indicator of how far the insertion has progressed (insertingAt).
344 *
345 * The insertingAt values are read when a process wants to flush WAL from
346 * the in-memory buffers to disk, to check that all the insertions to the
347 * region the process is about to write out have finished. You could simply
348 * wait for all currently in-progress insertions to finish, but the
349 * insertingAt indicator allows you to ignore insertions to later in the WAL,
350 * so that you only wait for the insertions that are modifying the buffers
351 * you're about to write out.
352 *
353 * This isn't just an optimization. If all the WAL buffers are dirty, an
354 * inserter that's holding a WAL insert lock might need to evict an old WAL
355 * buffer, which requires flushing the WAL. If it's possible for an inserter
356 * to block on another inserter unnecessarily, deadlock can arise when two
357 * inserters holding a WAL insert lock wait for each other to finish their
358 * insertion.
359 *
360 * Small WAL records that don't cross a page boundary never update the value,
361 * the WAL record is just copied to the page and the lock is released. But
362 * to avoid the deadlock-scenario explained above, the indicator is always
363 * updated before sleeping while holding an insertion lock.
364 *
365 * lastImportantAt contains the LSN of the last important WAL record inserted
366 * using a given lock. This value is used to detect if there has been
367 * important WAL activity since the last time some action, like a checkpoint,
368 * was performed - allowing to not repeat the action if not. The LSN is
369 * updated for all insertions, unless the XLOG_MARK_UNIMPORTANT flag was
370 * set. lastImportantAt is never cleared, only overwritten by the LSN of newer
371 * records. Tracking the WAL activity directly in WALInsertLock has the
372 * advantage of not needing any additional locks to update the value.
373 */
380
381/*
382 * All the WAL insertion locks are allocated as an array in shared memory. We
383 * force the array stride to be a power of 2, which saves a few cycles in
384 * indexing, but more importantly also ensures that individual slots don't
385 * cross cache line boundaries. (Of course, we have to also ensure that the
386 * array start address is suitably aligned.)
387 */
393
394/*
395 * Session status of running backup, used for sanity checks in SQL-callable
396 * functions to start and stop backups.
397 */
399
400/*
401 * Shared state data for WAL insertion.
402 */
403typedef struct XLogCtlInsert
404{
405 slock_t insertpos_lck; /* protects CurrBytePos and PrevBytePos */
406
407 /*
408 * CurrBytePos is the end of reserved WAL. The next record will be
409 * inserted at that position. PrevBytePos is the start position of the
410 * previously inserted (or rather, reserved) record - it is copied to the
411 * prev-link of the next record. These are stored as "usable byte
412 * positions" rather than XLogRecPtrs (see XLogBytePosToRecPtr()).
413 */
416
417 /*
418 * Make sure the above heavily-contended spinlock and byte positions are
419 * on their own cache line. In particular, the RedoRecPtr and full page
420 * write variables below should be on a different cache line. They are
421 * read on every WAL insertion, but updated rarely, and we don't want
422 * those reads to steal the cache line containing Curr/PrevBytePos.
423 */
425
426 /*
427 * fullPageWrites is the authoritative value used by all backends to
428 * determine whether to write full-page image to WAL. This shared value,
429 * instead of the process-local fullPageWrites, is required because, when
430 * full_page_writes is changed by SIGHUP, we must WAL-log it before it
431 * actually affects WAL-logging by backends. Checkpointer sets at startup
432 * or after SIGHUP.
433 *
434 * To read these fields, you must hold an insertion lock. To modify them,
435 * you must hold ALL the locks.
436 */
437 XLogRecPtr RedoRecPtr; /* current redo point for insertions */
439
440 /*
441 * runningBackups is a counter indicating the number of backups currently
442 * in progress. lastBackupStart is the latest checkpoint redo location
443 * used as a starting point for an online backup.
444 */
447
448 /*
449 * WAL insertion locks.
450 */
453
454/*
455 * Total shared-memory state for XLOG.
456 */
457typedef struct XLogCtlData
458{
460
461 /* Protected by info_lck: */
463 XLogRecPtr RedoRecPtr; /* a recent copy of Insert->RedoRecPtr */
464 XLogRecPtr asyncXactLSN; /* LSN of newest async commit/abort */
465 XLogRecPtr replicationSlotMinLSN; /* oldest LSN needed by any slot */
466
467 XLogSegNo lastRemovedSegNo; /* latest removed/recycled XLOG segment */
468
469 /* Fake LSN counter, for unlogged relations. */
471
472 /* Time and LSN of last xlog segment switch. Protected by WALWriteLock. */
475
476 /* These are accessed using atomics -- info_lck not needed */
477 pg_atomic_uint64 logInsertResult; /* last byte + 1 inserted to buffers */
478 pg_atomic_uint64 logWriteResult; /* last byte + 1 written out */
479 pg_atomic_uint64 logFlushResult; /* last byte + 1 flushed */
480
481 /*
482 * Latest initialized page in the cache (last byte position + 1).
483 *
484 * To change the identity of a buffer (and InitializedUpTo), you need to
485 * hold WALBufMappingLock. To change the identity of a buffer that's
486 * still dirty, the old page needs to be written out first, and for that
487 * you need WALWriteLock, and you need to ensure that there are no
488 * in-progress insertions to the page by calling
489 * WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish().
490 */
492
493 /*
494 * These values do not change after startup, although the pointed-to pages
495 * and xlblocks values certainly do. xlblocks values are protected by
496 * WALBufMappingLock.
497 */
498 char *pages; /* buffers for unwritten XLOG pages */
499 pg_atomic_uint64 *xlblocks; /* 1st byte ptr-s + XLOG_BLCKSZ */
500 int XLogCacheBlck; /* highest allocated xlog buffer index */
501
502 /*
503 * InsertTimeLineID is the timeline into which new WAL is being inserted
504 * and flushed. It is zero during recovery, and does not change once set.
505 *
506 * If we create a new timeline when the system was started up,
507 * PrevTimeLineID is the old timeline's ID that we forked off from.
508 * Otherwise it's equal to InsertTimeLineID.
509 *
510 * We set these fields while holding info_lck. Most that reads these
511 * values knows that recovery is no longer in progress and so can safely
512 * read the value without a lock, but code that could be run either during
513 * or after recovery can take info_lck while reading these values.
514 */
517
518 /*
519 * SharedRecoveryState indicates if we're still in crash or archive
520 * recovery. Protected by info_lck.
521 */
523
524 /*
525 * InstallXLogFileSegmentActive indicates whether the checkpointer should
526 * arrange for future segments by recycling and/or PreallocXlogFiles().
527 * Protected by ControlFileLock. Only the startup process changes it. If
528 * true, anyone can use InstallXLogFileSegment(). If false, the startup
529 * process owns the exclusive right to install segments, by reading from
530 * the archive and possibly replacing existing files.
531 */
533
534 /*
535 * WalWriterSleeping indicates whether the WAL writer is currently in
536 * low-power mode (and hence should be nudged if an async commit occurs).
537 * Protected by info_lck.
538 */
540
541 /*
542 * During recovery, we keep a copy of the latest checkpoint record here.
543 * lastCheckPointRecPtr points to start of checkpoint record and
544 * lastCheckPointEndPtr points to end+1 of checkpoint record. Used by the
545 * checkpointer when it wants to create a restartpoint.
546 *
547 * Protected by info_lck.
548 */
552
553 /*
554 * lastFpwDisableRecPtr points to the start of the last replayed
555 * XLOG_FPW_CHANGE record that instructs full_page_writes is disabled.
556 */
558
559 /* last data_checksum_version we've seen */
561
562 slock_t info_lck; /* locks shared variables shown above */
564
565/*
566 * Classification of XLogInsertRecord operations.
567 */
574
576
577/* a private copy of XLogCtl->Insert.WALInsertLocks, for convenience */
579
580/*
581 * We maintain an image of pg_control in shared memory.
582 */
585
586static void XLOGShmemRequest(void *arg);
587static void XLOGShmemInit(void *arg);
588static void XLOGShmemAttach(void *arg);
589
592 .init_fn = XLOGShmemInit,
593 .attach_fn = XLOGShmemAttach,
594};
595
596/*
597 * Calculate the amount of space left on the page after 'endptr'. Beware
598 * multiple evaluation!
599 */
600#define INSERT_FREESPACE(endptr) \
601 (((endptr) % XLOG_BLCKSZ == 0) ? 0 : (XLOG_BLCKSZ - (endptr) % XLOG_BLCKSZ))
602
603/* Macro to advance to next buffer index. */
604#define NextBufIdx(idx) \
605 (((idx) == XLogCtl->XLogCacheBlck) ? 0 : ((idx) + 1))
606
607/*
608 * XLogRecPtrToBufIdx returns the index of the WAL buffer that holds, or
609 * would hold if it was in cache, the page containing 'recptr'.
610 */
611#define XLogRecPtrToBufIdx(recptr) \
612 (((recptr) / XLOG_BLCKSZ) % (XLogCtl->XLogCacheBlck + 1))
613
614/*
615 * These are the number of bytes in a WAL page usable for WAL data.
616 */
617#define UsableBytesInPage (XLOG_BLCKSZ - SizeOfXLogShortPHD)
618
619/*
620 * Convert values of GUCs measured in megabytes to equiv. segment count.
621 * Rounds down.
622 */
623#define ConvertToXSegs(x, segsize) XLogMBVarToSegs((x), (segsize))
624
625/* The number of bytes in a WAL segment usable for WAL data. */
627
628/*
629 * Private, possibly out-of-date copy of shared LogwrtResult.
630 * See discussion above.
631 */
633
634/*
635 * Update local copy of shared XLogCtl->log{Write,Flush}Result
636 *
637 * It's critical that Flush always trails Write, so the order of the reads is
638 * important, as is the barrier. See also XLogWrite.
639 */
640#define RefreshXLogWriteResult(_target) \
641 do { \
642 _target.Flush = pg_atomic_read_u64(&XLogCtl->logFlushResult); \
643 pg_read_barrier(); \
644 _target.Write = pg_atomic_read_u64(&XLogCtl->logWriteResult); \
645 } while (0)
646
647/*
648 * openLogFile is -1 or a kernel FD for an open log file segment.
649 * openLogSegNo identifies the segment, and openLogTLI the corresponding TLI.
650 * These variables are only used to write the XLOG, and so will normally refer
651 * to the active segment.
652 *
653 * Note: call Reserve/ReleaseExternalFD to track consumption of this FD.
654 */
655static int openLogFile = -1;
658
659/*
660 * Local copies of equivalent fields in the control file. When running
661 * crash recovery, LocalMinRecoveryPoint is set to InvalidXLogRecPtr as we
662 * expect to replay all the WAL available, and updateMinRecoveryPoint is
663 * switched to false to prevent any updates while replaying records.
664 * Those values are kept consistent as long as crash recovery runs.
665 */
668static bool updateMinRecoveryPoint = true;
669
670/*
671 * Local state for ControlFile data_checksum_version. After initialization
672 * this is only updated when absorbing a procsignal barrier during interrupt
673 * processing. The reason for keeping a copy in backend-private memory is to
674 * avoid locking for interrogating the data checksum state. Possible values
675 * are the data checksum versions defined in storage/checksum.h.
676 */
678
679/*
680 * Variable backing the GUC, keep it in sync with LocalDataChecksumState.
681 * See SetLocalDataChecksumState().
682 */
684
685/* For WALInsertLockAcquire/Release functions */
686static int MyLockNo = 0;
687static bool holdingAllLocks = false;
688
689#ifdef WAL_DEBUG
691#endif
692
696static void CheckRequiredParameterValues(void);
697static void XLogReportParameters(void);
698static int LocalSetXLogInsertAllowed(void);
699static void CreateEndOfRecoveryRecord(void);
703static void CheckPointGuts(XLogRecPtr checkPointRedo, int flags);
705
707 bool opportunistic);
708static void XLogWrite(XLogwrtRqst WriteRqst, TimeLineID tli, bool flexible);
709static bool InstallXLogFileSegment(XLogSegNo *segno, char *tmppath,
711 TimeLineID tli);
712static void XLogFileClose(void);
713static void PreallocXlogFiles(XLogRecPtr endptr, TimeLineID tli);
714static void RemoveTempXlogFiles(void);
717static void RemoveXlogFile(const struct dirent *segment_de,
720static void UpdateLastRemovedPtr(char *filename);
721static void ValidateXLOGDirectoryStructure(void);
722static void CleanupBackupHistory(void);
723static void UpdateMinRecoveryPoint(XLogRecPtr lsn, bool force);
724static bool PerformRecoveryXLogAction(void);
725static void InitControlFile(uint64 sysidentifier, uint32 data_checksum_version);
726static void WriteControlFile(void);
727static void ReadControlFile(void);
728static void UpdateControlFile(void);
729static char *str_time(pg_time_t tnow, char *buf, size_t bufsize);
730
731static int get_sync_bit(int method);
732
733static void CopyXLogRecordToWAL(int write_len, bool isLogSwitch,
736 TimeLineID tli);
737static void ReserveXLogInsertLocation(int size, XLogRecPtr *StartPos,
742static char *GetXLogBuffer(XLogRecPtr ptr, TimeLineID tli);
746
747static void WALInsertLockAcquire(void);
748static void WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive(void);
749static void WALInsertLockRelease(void);
750static void WALInsertLockUpdateInsertingAt(XLogRecPtr insertingAt);
751
752static void XLogChecksums(uint32 new_type);
753
754/*
755 * Insert an XLOG record represented by an already-constructed chain of data
756 * chunks. This is a low-level routine; to construct the WAL record header
757 * and data, use the higher-level routines in xloginsert.c.
758 *
759 * If 'fpw_lsn' is valid, it is the oldest LSN among the pages that this
760 * WAL record applies to, that were not included in the record as full page
761 * images. If fpw_lsn <= RedoRecPtr, the function does not perform the
762 * insertion and returns InvalidXLogRecPtr. The caller can then recalculate
763 * which pages need a full-page image, and retry. If fpw_lsn is invalid, the
764 * record is always inserted.
765 *
766 * 'flags' gives more in-depth control on the record being inserted. See
767 * XLogSetRecordFlags() for details.
768 *
769 * 'topxid_included' tells whether the top-transaction id is logged along with
770 * current subtransaction. See XLogRecordAssemble().
771 *
772 * The first XLogRecData in the chain must be for the record header, and its
773 * data must be MAXALIGNed. XLogInsertRecord fills in the xl_prev and
774 * xl_crc fields in the header, the rest of the header must already be filled
775 * by the caller.
776 *
777 * Returns XLOG pointer to end of record (beginning of next record).
778 * This can be used as LSN for data pages affected by the logged action.
779 * (LSN is the XLOG point up to which the XLOG must be flushed to disk
780 * before the data page can be written out. This implements the basic
781 * WAL rule "write the log before the data".)
782 */
786 uint8 flags,
787 int num_fpi,
789 bool topxid_included)
790{
793 bool inserted;
794 XLogRecord *rechdr = (XLogRecord *) rdata->data;
795 uint8 info = rechdr->xl_info & ~XLR_INFO_MASK;
801
802 /* Does this record type require special handling? */
803 if (unlikely(rechdr->xl_rmid == RM_XLOG_ID))
804 {
805 if (info == XLOG_SWITCH)
807 else if (info == XLOG_CHECKPOINT_REDO)
809 }
810
811 /* we assume that all of the record header is in the first chunk */
813
814 /* cross-check on whether we should be here or not */
815 if (!XLogInsertAllowed())
816 elog(ERROR, "cannot make new WAL entries during recovery");
817
818 /*
819 * Given that we're not in recovery, InsertTimeLineID is set and can't
820 * change, so we can read it without a lock.
821 */
823
824 /*----------
825 *
826 * We have now done all the preparatory work we can without holding a
827 * lock or modifying shared state. From here on, inserting the new WAL
828 * record to the shared WAL buffer cache is a two-step process:
829 *
830 * 1. Reserve the right amount of space from the WAL. The current head of
831 * reserved space is kept in Insert->CurrBytePos, and is protected by
832 * insertpos_lck.
833 *
834 * 2. Copy the record to the reserved WAL space. This involves finding the
835 * correct WAL buffer containing the reserved space, and copying the
836 * record in place. This can be done concurrently in multiple processes.
837 *
838 * To keep track of which insertions are still in-progress, each concurrent
839 * inserter acquires an insertion lock. In addition to just indicating that
840 * an insertion is in progress, the lock tells others how far the inserter
841 * has progressed. There is a small fixed number of insertion locks,
842 * determined by NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS. When an inserter crosses a page
843 * boundary, it updates the value stored in the lock to the how far it has
844 * inserted, to allow the previous buffer to be flushed.
845 *
846 * Holding onto an insertion lock also protects RedoRecPtr and
847 * fullPageWrites from changing until the insertion is finished.
848 *
849 * Step 2 can usually be done completely in parallel. If the required WAL
850 * page is not initialized yet, you have to grab WALBufMappingLock to
851 * initialize it, but the WAL writer tries to do that ahead of insertions
852 * to avoid that from happening in the critical path.
853 *
854 *----------
855 */
857
858 if (likely(class == WALINSERT_NORMAL))
859 {
861
862 /*
863 * Check to see if my copy of RedoRecPtr is out of date. If so, may
864 * have to go back and have the caller recompute everything. This can
865 * only happen just after a checkpoint, so it's better to be slow in
866 * this case and fast otherwise.
867 *
868 * Also check to see if fullPageWrites was just turned on or there's a
869 * running backup (which forces full-page writes); if we weren't
870 * already doing full-page writes then go back and recompute.
871 *
872 * If we aren't doing full-page writes then RedoRecPtr doesn't
873 * actually affect the contents of the XLOG record, so we'll update
874 * our local copy but not force a recomputation. (If doPageWrites was
875 * just turned off, we could recompute the record without full pages,
876 * but we choose not to bother.)
877 */
878 if (RedoRecPtr != Insert->RedoRecPtr)
879 {
881 RedoRecPtr = Insert->RedoRecPtr;
882 }
883 doPageWrites = (Insert->fullPageWrites || Insert->runningBackups > 0);
884
885 if (doPageWrites &&
888 {
889 /*
890 * Oops, some buffer now needs to be backed up that the caller
891 * didn't back up. Start over.
892 */
895 return InvalidXLogRecPtr;
896 }
897
898 /*
899 * Reserve space for the record in the WAL. This also sets the xl_prev
900 * pointer.
901 */
903 &rechdr->xl_prev);
904
905 /* Normal records are always inserted. */
906 inserted = true;
907 }
908 else if (class == WALINSERT_SPECIAL_SWITCH)
909 {
910 /*
911 * In order to insert an XLOG_SWITCH record, we need to hold all of
912 * the WAL insertion locks, not just one, so that no one else can
913 * begin inserting a record until we've figured out how much space
914 * remains in the current WAL segment and claimed all of it.
915 *
916 * Nonetheless, this case is simpler than the normal cases handled
917 * below, which must check for changes in doPageWrites and RedoRecPtr.
918 * Those checks are only needed for records that can contain buffer
919 * references, and an XLOG_SWITCH record never does.
920 */
924 }
925 else
926 {
928
929 /*
930 * We need to update both the local and shared copies of RedoRecPtr,
931 * which means that we need to hold all the WAL insertion locks.
932 * However, there can't be any buffer references, so as above, we need
933 * not check RedoRecPtr before inserting the record; we just need to
934 * update it afterwards.
935 */
939 &rechdr->xl_prev);
940 RedoRecPtr = Insert->RedoRecPtr = StartPos;
941 inserted = true;
942 }
943
944 if (inserted)
945 {
946 /*
947 * Now that xl_prev has been filled in, calculate CRC of the record
948 * header.
949 */
950 rdata_crc = rechdr->xl_crc;
953 rechdr->xl_crc = rdata_crc;
954
955 /*
956 * All the record data, including the header, is now ready to be
957 * inserted. Copy the record in the space reserved.
958 */
959 CopyXLogRecordToWAL(rechdr->xl_tot_len,
962
963 /*
964 * Unless record is flagged as not important, update LSN of last
965 * important record in the current slot. When holding all locks, just
966 * update the first one.
967 */
968 if ((flags & XLOG_MARK_UNIMPORTANT) == 0)
969 {
970 int lockno = holdingAllLocks ? 0 : MyLockNo;
971
973 }
974 }
975 else
976 {
977 /*
978 * This was an xlog-switch record, but the current insert location was
979 * already exactly at the beginning of a segment, so there was no need
980 * to do anything.
981 */
982 }
983
984 /*
985 * Done! Let others know that we're finished.
986 */
988
990
992
993 /*
994 * Mark top transaction id is logged (if needed) so that we should not try
995 * to log it again with the next WAL record in the current subtransaction.
996 */
997 if (topxid_included)
999
1000 /*
1001 * Update shared LogwrtRqst.Write, if we crossed page boundary.
1002 */
1004 {
1006 /* advance global request to include new block(s) */
1011 }
1012
1013 /*
1014 * If this was an XLOG_SWITCH record, flush the record and the empty
1015 * padding space that fills the rest of the segment, and perform
1016 * end-of-segment actions (eg, notifying archiver).
1017 */
1018 if (class == WALINSERT_SPECIAL_SWITCH)
1019 {
1022
1023 /*
1024 * Even though we reserved the rest of the segment for us, which is
1025 * reflected in EndPos, we return a pointer to just the end of the
1026 * xlog-switch record.
1027 */
1028 if (inserted)
1029 {
1032 {
1034
1035 if (offset == EndPos % XLOG_BLCKSZ)
1037 else
1039 }
1040 }
1041 }
1042
1043#ifdef WAL_DEBUG
1044 if (XLOG_DEBUG)
1045 {
1047 XLogRecord *record;
1051 char *errormsg = NULL;
1053
1055
1057 appendStringInfo(&buf, "INSERT @ %X/%08X: ", LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(EndPos));
1058
1059 /*
1060 * We have to piece together the WAL record data from the XLogRecData
1061 * entries, so that we can pass it to the rm_desc function as one
1062 * contiguous chunk.
1063 */
1065 for (; rdata != NULL; rdata = rdata->next)
1067
1068 /* We also need temporary space to decode the record. */
1069 record = (XLogRecord *) recordBuf.data;
1072
1073 if (!debug_reader)
1075 XL_ROUTINE(.page_read = NULL,
1076 .segment_open = NULL,
1077 .segment_close = NULL),
1078 NULL);
1079 if (!debug_reader)
1080 {
1081 appendStringInfoString(&buf, "error decoding record: out of memory while allocating a WAL reading processor");
1082 }
1084 decoded,
1085 record,
1086 EndPos,
1087 &errormsg))
1088 {
1089 appendStringInfo(&buf, "error decoding record: %s",
1090 errormsg ? errormsg : "no error message");
1091 }
1092 else
1093 {
1094 appendStringInfoString(&buf, " - ");
1095
1096 debug_reader->record = decoded;
1098 debug_reader->record = NULL;
1099 }
1100 elog(LOG, "%s", buf.data);
1101
1102 pfree(decoded);
1103 pfree(buf.data);
1104 pfree(recordBuf.data);
1106 }
1107#endif
1108
1109 /*
1110 * Update our global variables
1111 */
1114
1115 /* Report WAL traffic to the instrumentation. */
1116 if (inserted)
1117 {
1118 pgWalUsage.wal_bytes += rechdr->xl_tot_len;
1122
1123 /* Required for the flush of pending stats WAL data */
1124 pgstat_report_fixed = true;
1125 }
1126
1127 return EndPos;
1128}
1129
1130/*
1131 * Reserves the right amount of space for a record of given size from the WAL.
1132 * *StartPos is set to the beginning of the reserved section, *EndPos to
1133 * its end+1. *PrevPtr is set to the beginning of the previous record; it is
1134 * used to set the xl_prev of this record.
1135 *
1136 * This is the performance critical part of XLogInsert that must be serialized
1137 * across backends. The rest can happen mostly in parallel. Try to keep this
1138 * section as short as possible, insertpos_lck can be heavily contended on a
1139 * busy system.
1140 *
1141 * NB: The space calculation here must match the code in CopyXLogRecordToWAL,
1142 * where we actually copy the record to the reserved space.
1143 *
1144 * NB: Testing shows that XLogInsertRecord runs faster if this code is inlined;
1145 * however, because there are two call sites, the compiler is reluctant to
1146 * inline. We use pg_attribute_always_inline here to try to convince it.
1147 */
1151{
1156
1157 size = MAXALIGN(size);
1158
1159 /* All (non xlog-switch) records should contain data. */
1160 Assert(size > SizeOfXLogRecord);
1161
1162 /*
1163 * The duration the spinlock needs to be held is minimized by minimizing
1164 * the calculations that have to be done while holding the lock. The
1165 * current tip of reserved WAL is kept in CurrBytePos, as a byte position
1166 * that only counts "usable" bytes in WAL, that is, it excludes all WAL
1167 * page headers. The mapping between "usable" byte positions and physical
1168 * positions (XLogRecPtrs) can be done outside the locked region, and
1169 * because the usable byte position doesn't include any headers, reserving
1170 * X bytes from WAL is almost as simple as "CurrBytePos += X".
1171 */
1172 SpinLockAcquire(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
1173
1174 startbytepos = Insert->CurrBytePos;
1175 endbytepos = startbytepos + size;
1176 prevbytepos = Insert->PrevBytePos;
1177 Insert->CurrBytePos = endbytepos;
1178 Insert->PrevBytePos = startbytepos;
1179
1180 SpinLockRelease(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
1181
1185
1186 /*
1187 * Check that the conversions between "usable byte positions" and
1188 * XLogRecPtrs work consistently in both directions.
1189 */
1193}
1194
1195/*
1196 * Like ReserveXLogInsertLocation(), but for an xlog-switch record.
1197 *
1198 * A log-switch record is handled slightly differently. The rest of the
1199 * segment will be reserved for this insertion, as indicated by the returned
1200 * *EndPos value. However, if we are already at the beginning of the current
1201 * segment, *StartPos and *EndPos are set to the current location without
1202 * reserving any space, and the function returns false.
1203 */
1204static bool
1206{
1212 XLogRecPtr ptr;
1214
1215 /*
1216 * These calculations are a bit heavy-weight to be done while holding a
1217 * spinlock, but since we're holding all the WAL insertion locks, there
1218 * are no other inserters competing for it. GetXLogInsertRecPtr() does
1219 * compete for it, but that's not called very frequently.
1220 */
1221 SpinLockAcquire(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
1222
1223 startbytepos = Insert->CurrBytePos;
1224
1226 if (XLogSegmentOffset(ptr, wal_segment_size) == 0)
1227 {
1228 SpinLockRelease(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
1229 *EndPos = *StartPos = ptr;
1230 return false;
1231 }
1232
1233 endbytepos = startbytepos + size;
1234 prevbytepos = Insert->PrevBytePos;
1235
1238
1241 {
1242 /* consume the rest of the segment */
1243 *EndPos += segleft;
1245 }
1246 Insert->CurrBytePos = endbytepos;
1247 Insert->PrevBytePos = startbytepos;
1248
1249 SpinLockRelease(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
1250
1252
1257
1258 return true;
1259}
1260
1261/*
1262 * Subroutine of XLogInsertRecord. Copies a WAL record to an already-reserved
1263 * area in the WAL.
1264 */
1265static void
1268{
1269 char *currpos;
1270 int freespace;
1271 int written;
1274
1275 /*
1276 * Get a pointer to the right place in the right WAL buffer to start
1277 * inserting to.
1278 */
1279 CurrPos = StartPos;
1280 currpos = GetXLogBuffer(CurrPos, tli);
1281 freespace = INSERT_FREESPACE(CurrPos);
1282
1283 /*
1284 * there should be enough space for at least the first field (xl_tot_len)
1285 * on this page.
1286 */
1287 Assert(freespace >= sizeof(uint32));
1288
1289 /* Copy record data */
1290 written = 0;
1291 while (rdata != NULL)
1292 {
1293 const char *rdata_data = rdata->data;
1294 int rdata_len = rdata->len;
1295
1296 while (rdata_len > freespace)
1297 {
1298 /*
1299 * Write what fits on this page, and continue on the next page.
1300 */
1301 Assert(CurrPos % XLOG_BLCKSZ >= SizeOfXLogShortPHD || freespace == 0);
1302 memcpy(currpos, rdata_data, freespace);
1303 rdata_data += freespace;
1304 rdata_len -= freespace;
1305 written += freespace;
1306 CurrPos += freespace;
1307
1308 /*
1309 * Get pointer to beginning of next page, and set the xlp_rem_len
1310 * in the page header. Set XLP_FIRST_IS_CONTRECORD.
1311 *
1312 * It's safe to set the contrecord flag and xlp_rem_len without a
1313 * lock on the page. All the other flags were already set when the
1314 * page was initialized, in AdvanceXLInsertBuffer, and we're the
1315 * only backend that needs to set the contrecord flag.
1316 */
1317 currpos = GetXLogBuffer(CurrPos, tli);
1318 pagehdr = (XLogPageHeader) currpos;
1319 pagehdr->xlp_rem_len = write_len - written;
1320 pagehdr->xlp_info |= XLP_FIRST_IS_CONTRECORD;
1321
1322 /* skip over the page header */
1324 {
1326 currpos += SizeOfXLogLongPHD;
1327 }
1328 else
1329 {
1331 currpos += SizeOfXLogShortPHD;
1332 }
1333 freespace = INSERT_FREESPACE(CurrPos);
1334 }
1335
1336 Assert(CurrPos % XLOG_BLCKSZ >= SizeOfXLogShortPHD || rdata_len == 0);
1337 memcpy(currpos, rdata_data, rdata_len);
1338 currpos += rdata_len;
1339 CurrPos += rdata_len;
1340 freespace -= rdata_len;
1341 written += rdata_len;
1342
1343 rdata = rdata->next;
1344 }
1346
1347 /*
1348 * If this was an xlog-switch, it's not enough to write the switch record,
1349 * we also have to consume all the remaining space in the WAL segment. We
1350 * have already reserved that space, but we need to actually fill it.
1351 */
1353 {
1354 /* An xlog-switch record doesn't contain any data besides the header */
1356
1357 /* Assert that we did reserve the right amount of space */
1359
1360 /* Use up all the remaining space on the current page */
1361 CurrPos += freespace;
1362
1363 /*
1364 * Cause all remaining pages in the segment to be flushed, leaving the
1365 * XLog position where it should be, at the start of the next segment.
1366 * We do this one page at a time, to make sure we don't deadlock
1367 * against ourselves if wal_buffers < wal_segment_size.
1368 */
1369 while (CurrPos < EndPos)
1370 {
1371 /*
1372 * The minimal action to flush the page would be to call
1373 * WALInsertLockUpdateInsertingAt(CurrPos) followed by
1374 * AdvanceXLInsertBuffer(...). The page would be left initialized
1375 * mostly to zeros, except for the page header (always the short
1376 * variant, as this is never a segment's first page).
1377 *
1378 * The large vistas of zeros are good for compressibility, but the
1379 * headers interrupting them every XLOG_BLCKSZ (with values that
1380 * differ from page to page) are not. The effect varies with
1381 * compression tool, but bzip2 for instance compresses about an
1382 * order of magnitude worse if those headers are left in place.
1383 *
1384 * Rather than complicating AdvanceXLInsertBuffer itself (which is
1385 * called in heavily-loaded circumstances as well as this lightly-
1386 * loaded one) with variant behavior, we just use GetXLogBuffer
1387 * (which itself calls the two methods we need) to get the pointer
1388 * and zero most of the page. Then we just zero the page header.
1389 */
1390 currpos = GetXLogBuffer(CurrPos, tli);
1391 MemSet(currpos, 0, SizeOfXLogShortPHD);
1392
1394 }
1395 }
1396 else
1397 {
1398 /* Align the end position, so that the next record starts aligned */
1400 }
1401
1402 if (CurrPos != EndPos)
1403 ereport(PANIC,
1405 errmsg_internal("space reserved for WAL record does not match what was written"));
1406}
1407
1408/*
1409 * Acquire a WAL insertion lock, for inserting to WAL.
1410 */
1411static void
1413{
1414 bool immed;
1415
1416 /*
1417 * It doesn't matter which of the WAL insertion locks we acquire, so try
1418 * the one we used last time. If the system isn't particularly busy, it's
1419 * a good bet that it's still available, and it's good to have some
1420 * affinity to a particular lock so that you don't unnecessarily bounce
1421 * cache lines between processes when there's no contention.
1422 *
1423 * If this is the first time through in this backend, pick a lock
1424 * (semi-)randomly. This allows the locks to be used evenly if you have a
1425 * lot of very short connections.
1426 */
1427 static int lockToTry = -1;
1428
1429 if (lockToTry == -1)
1432
1433 /*
1434 * The insertingAt value is initially set to 0, as we don't know our
1435 * insert location yet.
1436 */
1438 if (!immed)
1439 {
1440 /*
1441 * If we couldn't get the lock immediately, try another lock next
1442 * time. On a system with more insertion locks than concurrent
1443 * inserters, this causes all the inserters to eventually migrate to a
1444 * lock that no-one else is using. On a system with more inserters
1445 * than locks, it still helps to distribute the inserters evenly
1446 * across the locks.
1447 */
1449 }
1450}
1451
1452/*
1453 * Acquire all WAL insertion locks, to prevent other backends from inserting
1454 * to WAL.
1455 */
1456static void
1458{
1459 int i;
1460
1461 /*
1462 * When holding all the locks, all but the last lock's insertingAt
1463 * indicator is set to 0xFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFF, which is higher than any real
1464 * XLogRecPtr value, to make sure that no-one blocks waiting on those.
1465 */
1466 for (i = 0; i < NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS - 1; i++)
1467 {
1472 }
1473 /* Variable value reset to 0 at release */
1475
1476 holdingAllLocks = true;
1477}
1478
1479/*
1480 * Release our insertion lock (or locks, if we're holding them all).
1481 *
1482 * NB: Reset all variables to 0, so they cause LWLockWaitForVar to block the
1483 * next time the lock is acquired.
1484 */
1485static void
1487{
1488 if (holdingAllLocks)
1489 {
1490 int i;
1491
1492 for (i = 0; i < NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS; i++)
1495 0);
1496
1497 holdingAllLocks = false;
1498 }
1499 else
1500 {
1503 0);
1504 }
1505}
1506
1507/*
1508 * Update our insertingAt value, to let others know that we've finished
1509 * inserting up to that point.
1510 */
1511static void
1513{
1514 if (holdingAllLocks)
1515 {
1516 /*
1517 * We use the last lock to mark our actual position, see comments in
1518 * WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive.
1519 */
1522 insertingAt);
1523 }
1524 else
1527 insertingAt);
1528}
1529
1530/*
1531 * Wait for any WAL insertions < upto to finish.
1532 *
1533 * Returns the location of the oldest insertion that is still in-progress.
1534 * Any WAL prior to that point has been fully copied into WAL buffers, and
1535 * can be flushed out to disk. Because this waits for any insertions older
1536 * than 'upto' to finish, the return value is always >= 'upto'.
1537 *
1538 * Note: When you are about to write out WAL, you must call this function
1539 * *before* acquiring WALWriteLock, to avoid deadlocks. This function might
1540 * need to wait for an insertion to finish (or at least advance to next
1541 * uninitialized page), and the inserter might need to evict an old WAL buffer
1542 * to make room for a new one, which in turn requires WALWriteLock.
1543 */
1544static XLogRecPtr
1546{
1552 int i;
1553
1554 if (MyProc == NULL)
1555 elog(PANIC, "cannot wait without a PGPROC structure");
1556
1557 /*
1558 * Check if there's any work to do. Use a barrier to ensure we get the
1559 * freshest value.
1560 */
1562 if (upto <= inserted)
1563 return inserted;
1564
1565 /* Read the current insert position */
1566 SpinLockAcquire(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
1567 bytepos = Insert->CurrBytePos;
1568 SpinLockRelease(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
1570
1571 /*
1572 * No-one should request to flush a piece of WAL that hasn't even been
1573 * reserved yet. However, it can happen if there is a block with a bogus
1574 * LSN on disk, for example. XLogFlush checks for that situation and
1575 * complains, but only after the flush. Here we just assume that to mean
1576 * that all WAL that has been reserved needs to be finished. In this
1577 * corner-case, the return value can be smaller than 'upto' argument.
1578 */
1579 if (upto > reservedUpto)
1580 {
1581 ereport(LOG,
1582 errmsg("request to flush past end of generated WAL; request %X/%08X, current position %X/%08X",
1585 }
1586
1587 /*
1588 * Loop through all the locks, sleeping on any in-progress insert older
1589 * than 'upto'.
1590 *
1591 * finishedUpto is our return value, indicating the point upto which all
1592 * the WAL insertions have been finished. Initialize it to the head of
1593 * reserved WAL, and as we iterate through the insertion locks, back it
1594 * out for any insertion that's still in progress.
1595 */
1597 for (i = 0; i < NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS; i++)
1598 {
1600
1601 do
1602 {
1603 /*
1604 * See if this insertion is in progress. LWLockWaitForVar will
1605 * wait for the lock to be released, or for the 'value' to be set
1606 * by a LWLockUpdateVar call. When a lock is initially acquired,
1607 * its value is 0 (InvalidXLogRecPtr), which means that we don't
1608 * know where it's inserting yet. We will have to wait for it. If
1609 * it's a small insertion, the record will most likely fit on the
1610 * same page and the inserter will release the lock without ever
1611 * calling LWLockUpdateVar. But if it has to sleep, it will
1612 * advertise the insertion point with LWLockUpdateVar before
1613 * sleeping.
1614 *
1615 * In this loop we are only waiting for insertions that started
1616 * before WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish was called. The lack of
1617 * memory barriers in the loop means that we might see locks as
1618 * "unused" that have since become used. This is fine because
1619 * they only can be used for later insertions that we would not
1620 * want to wait on anyway. Not taking a lock to acquire the
1621 * current insertingAt value means that we might see older
1622 * insertingAt values. This is also fine, because if we read a
1623 * value too old, we will add ourselves to the wait queue, which
1624 * contains atomic operations.
1625 */
1626 if (LWLockWaitForVar(&WALInsertLocks[i].l.lock,
1629 {
1630 /* the lock was free, so no insertion in progress */
1632 break;
1633 }
1634
1635 /*
1636 * This insertion is still in progress. Have to wait, unless the
1637 * inserter has proceeded past 'upto'.
1638 */
1639 } while (insertingat < upto);
1640
1643 }
1644
1645 /*
1646 * Advance the limit we know to have been inserted and return the freshest
1647 * value we know of, which might be beyond what we requested if somebody
1648 * is concurrently doing this with an 'upto' pointer ahead of us.
1649 */
1651 finishedUpto);
1652
1653 return finishedUpto;
1654}
1655
1656/*
1657 * Get a pointer to the right location in the WAL buffer containing the
1658 * given XLogRecPtr.
1659 *
1660 * If the page is not initialized yet, it is initialized. That might require
1661 * evicting an old dirty buffer from the buffer cache, which means I/O.
1662 *
1663 * The caller must ensure that the page containing the requested location
1664 * isn't evicted yet, and won't be evicted. The way to ensure that is to
1665 * hold onto a WAL insertion lock with the insertingAt position set to
1666 * something <= ptr. GetXLogBuffer() will update insertingAt if it needs
1667 * to evict an old page from the buffer. (This means that once you call
1668 * GetXLogBuffer() with a given 'ptr', you must not access anything before
1669 * that point anymore, and must not call GetXLogBuffer() with an older 'ptr'
1670 * later, because older buffers might be recycled already)
1671 */
1672static char *
1674{
1675 int idx;
1676 XLogRecPtr endptr;
1677 static uint64 cachedPage = 0;
1678 static char *cachedPos = NULL;
1680
1681 /*
1682 * Fast path for the common case that we need to access again the same
1683 * page as last time.
1684 */
1685 if (ptr / XLOG_BLCKSZ == cachedPage)
1686 {
1688 Assert(((XLogPageHeader) cachedPos)->xlp_pageaddr == ptr - (ptr % XLOG_BLCKSZ));
1689 return cachedPos + ptr % XLOG_BLCKSZ;
1690 }
1691
1692 /*
1693 * The XLog buffer cache is organized so that a page is always loaded to a
1694 * particular buffer. That way we can easily calculate the buffer a given
1695 * page must be loaded into, from the XLogRecPtr alone.
1696 */
1697 idx = XLogRecPtrToBufIdx(ptr);
1698
1699 /*
1700 * See what page is loaded in the buffer at the moment. It could be the
1701 * page we're looking for, or something older. It can't be anything newer
1702 * - that would imply the page we're looking for has already been written
1703 * out to disk and evicted, and the caller is responsible for making sure
1704 * that doesn't happen.
1705 *
1706 * We don't hold a lock while we read the value. If someone is just about
1707 * to initialize or has just initialized the page, it's possible that we
1708 * get InvalidXLogRecPtr. That's ok, we'll grab the mapping lock (in
1709 * AdvanceXLInsertBuffer) and retry if we see anything other than the page
1710 * we're looking for.
1711 */
1712 expectedEndPtr = ptr;
1714
1716 if (expectedEndPtr != endptr)
1717 {
1719
1720 /*
1721 * Before calling AdvanceXLInsertBuffer(), which can block, let others
1722 * know how far we're finished with inserting the record.
1723 *
1724 * NB: If 'ptr' points to just after the page header, advertise a
1725 * position at the beginning of the page rather than 'ptr' itself. If
1726 * there are no other insertions running, someone might try to flush
1727 * up to our advertised location. If we advertised a position after
1728 * the page header, someone might try to flush the page header, even
1729 * though page might actually not be initialized yet. As the first
1730 * inserter on the page, we are effectively responsible for making
1731 * sure that it's initialized, before we let insertingAt to move past
1732 * the page header.
1733 */
1734 if (ptr % XLOG_BLCKSZ == SizeOfXLogShortPHD &&
1737 else if (ptr % XLOG_BLCKSZ == SizeOfXLogLongPHD &&
1740 else
1741 initializedUpto = ptr;
1742
1744
1745 AdvanceXLInsertBuffer(ptr, tli, false);
1747
1748 if (expectedEndPtr != endptr)
1749 elog(PANIC, "could not find WAL buffer for %X/%08X",
1750 LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(ptr));
1751 }
1752 else
1753 {
1754 /*
1755 * Make sure the initialization of the page is visible to us, and
1756 * won't arrive later to overwrite the WAL data we write on the page.
1757 */
1759 }
1760
1761 /*
1762 * Found the buffer holding this page. Return a pointer to the right
1763 * offset within the page.
1764 */
1765 cachedPage = ptr / XLOG_BLCKSZ;
1767
1769 Assert(((XLogPageHeader) cachedPos)->xlp_pageaddr == ptr - (ptr % XLOG_BLCKSZ));
1770
1771 return cachedPos + ptr % XLOG_BLCKSZ;
1772}
1773
1774/*
1775 * Read WAL data directly from WAL buffers, if available. Returns the number
1776 * of bytes read successfully.
1777 *
1778 * Fewer than 'count' bytes may be read if some of the requested WAL data has
1779 * already been evicted.
1780 *
1781 * No locks are taken.
1782 *
1783 * Caller should ensure that it reads no further than LogwrtResult.Write
1784 * (which should have been updated by the caller when determining how far to
1785 * read). The 'tli' argument is only used as a convenient safety check so that
1786 * callers do not read from WAL buffers on a historical timeline.
1787 */
1788Size
1790 TimeLineID tli)
1791{
1792 char *pdst = dstbuf;
1793 XLogRecPtr recptr = startptr;
1795 Size nbytes = count;
1796
1798 return 0;
1799
1800 Assert(XLogRecPtrIsValid(startptr));
1801
1802 /*
1803 * Caller should ensure that the requested data has been inserted into WAL
1804 * buffers before we try to read it.
1805 */
1807 if (startptr + count > inserted)
1808 ereport(ERROR,
1809 errmsg("cannot read past end of generated WAL: requested %X/%08X, current position %X/%08X",
1810 LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(startptr + count),
1812
1813 /*
1814 * Loop through the buffers without a lock. For each buffer, atomically
1815 * read and verify the end pointer, then copy the data out, and finally
1816 * re-read and re-verify the end pointer.
1817 *
1818 * Once a page is evicted, it never returns to the WAL buffers, so if the
1819 * end pointer matches the expected end pointer before and after we copy
1820 * the data, then the right page must have been present during the data
1821 * copy. Read barriers are necessary to ensure that the data copy actually
1822 * happens between the two verification steps.
1823 *
1824 * If either verification fails, we simply terminate the loop and return
1825 * with the data that had been already copied out successfully.
1826 */
1827 while (nbytes > 0)
1828 {
1829 uint32 offset = recptr % XLOG_BLCKSZ;
1832 XLogRecPtr endptr;
1833 const char *page;
1834 const char *psrc;
1836
1837 /*
1838 * Calculate the end pointer we expect in the xlblocks array if the
1839 * correct page is present.
1840 */
1841 expectedEndPtr = recptr + (XLOG_BLCKSZ - offset);
1842
1843 /*
1844 * First verification step: check that the correct page is present in
1845 * the WAL buffers.
1846 */
1848 if (expectedEndPtr != endptr)
1849 break;
1850
1851 /*
1852 * The correct page is present (or was at the time the endptr was
1853 * read; must re-verify later). Calculate pointer to source data and
1854 * determine how much data to read from this page.
1855 */
1856 page = XLogCtl->pages + idx * (Size) XLOG_BLCKSZ;
1857 psrc = page + offset;
1858 npagebytes = Min(nbytes, XLOG_BLCKSZ - offset);
1859
1860 /*
1861 * Ensure that the data copy and the first verification step are not
1862 * reordered.
1863 */
1865
1866 /* data copy */
1868
1869 /*
1870 * Ensure that the data copy and the second verification step are not
1871 * reordered.
1872 */
1874
1875 /*
1876 * Second verification step: check that the page we read from wasn't
1877 * evicted while we were copying the data.
1878 */
1880 if (expectedEndPtr != endptr)
1881 break;
1882
1883 pdst += npagebytes;
1884 recptr += npagebytes;
1885 nbytes -= npagebytes;
1886 }
1887
1888 Assert(pdst - dstbuf <= count);
1889
1890 return pdst - dstbuf;
1891}
1892
1893/*
1894 * Converts a "usable byte position" to XLogRecPtr. A usable byte position
1895 * is the position starting from the beginning of WAL, excluding all WAL
1896 * page headers.
1897 */
1898static XLogRecPtr
1900{
1906
1909
1911 {
1912 /* fits on first page of segment */
1914 }
1915 else
1916 {
1917 /* account for the first page on segment with long header */
1920
1923
1925 }
1926
1928
1929 return result;
1930}
1931
1932/*
1933 * Like XLogBytePosToRecPtr, but if the position is at a page boundary,
1934 * returns a pointer to the beginning of the page (ie. before page header),
1935 * not to where the first xlog record on that page would go to. This is used
1936 * when converting a pointer to the end of a record.
1937 */
1938static XLogRecPtr
1940{
1946
1949
1951 {
1952 /* fits on first page of segment */
1953 if (bytesleft == 0)
1954 seg_offset = 0;
1955 else
1957 }
1958 else
1959 {
1960 /* account for the first page on segment with long header */
1963
1966
1967 if (bytesleft == 0)
1969 else
1971 }
1972
1974
1975 return result;
1976}
1977
1978/*
1979 * Convert an XLogRecPtr to a "usable byte position".
1980 */
1981static uint64
1983{
1986 uint32 offset;
1987 uint64 result;
1988
1990
1992 offset = ptr % XLOG_BLCKSZ;
1993
1994 if (fullpages == 0)
1995 {
1997 if (offset > 0)
1998 {
1999 Assert(offset >= SizeOfXLogLongPHD);
2000 result += offset - SizeOfXLogLongPHD;
2001 }
2002 }
2003 else
2004 {
2006 (XLOG_BLCKSZ - SizeOfXLogLongPHD) + /* account for first page */
2007 (fullpages - 1) * UsableBytesInPage; /* full pages */
2008 if (offset > 0)
2009 {
2010 Assert(offset >= SizeOfXLogShortPHD);
2011 result += offset - SizeOfXLogShortPHD;
2012 }
2013 }
2014
2015 return result;
2016}
2017
2018/*
2019 * Initialize XLOG buffers, writing out old buffers if they still contain
2020 * unwritten data, upto the page containing 'upto'. Or if 'opportunistic' is
2021 * true, initialize as many pages as we can without having to write out
2022 * unwritten data. Any new pages are initialized to zeros, with pages headers
2023 * initialized properly.
2024 */
2025static void
2027{
2028 int nextidx;
2034 int npages pg_attribute_unused() = 0;
2035
2037
2038 /*
2039 * Now that we have the lock, check if someone initialized the page
2040 * already.
2041 */
2043 {
2045
2046 /*
2047 * Get ending-offset of the buffer page we need to replace (this may
2048 * be zero if the buffer hasn't been used yet). Fall through if it's
2049 * already written out.
2050 */
2053 {
2054 /*
2055 * Nope, got work to do. If we just want to pre-initialize as much
2056 * as we can without flushing, give up now.
2057 */
2058 if (opportunistic)
2059 break;
2060
2061 /* Advance shared memory write request position */
2066
2067 /*
2068 * Acquire an up-to-date LogwrtResult value and see if we still
2069 * need to write it or if someone else already did.
2070 */
2073 {
2074 /*
2075 * Must acquire write lock. Release WALBufMappingLock first,
2076 * to make sure that all insertions that we need to wait for
2077 * can finish (up to this same position). Otherwise we risk
2078 * deadlock.
2079 */
2081
2083
2085
2088 {
2089 /* OK, someone wrote it already */
2091 }
2092 else
2093 {
2094 /* Have to write it ourselves */
2096 WriteRqst.Write = OldPageRqstPtr;
2098 XLogWrite(WriteRqst, tli, false);
2102
2103 /*
2104 * Required for the flush of pending stats WAL data, per
2105 * update of pgWalUsage.
2106 */
2107 pgstat_report_fixed = true;
2108 }
2109 /* Re-acquire WALBufMappingLock and retry */
2111 continue;
2112 }
2113 }
2114
2115 /*
2116 * Now the next buffer slot is free and we can set it up to be the
2117 * next output page.
2118 */
2121
2123
2125
2126 /*
2127 * Mark the xlblock with InvalidXLogRecPtr and issue a write barrier
2128 * before initializing. Otherwise, the old page may be partially
2129 * zeroed but look valid.
2130 */
2133
2134 /*
2135 * Be sure to re-zero the buffer so that bytes beyond what we've
2136 * written will look like zeroes and not valid XLOG records...
2137 */
2139
2140 /*
2141 * Fill the new page's header
2142 */
2143 NewPage->xlp_magic = XLOG_PAGE_MAGIC;
2144
2145 /* NewPage->xlp_info = 0; */ /* done by memset */
2146 NewPage->xlp_tli = tli;
2147 NewPage->xlp_pageaddr = NewPageBeginPtr;
2148
2149 /* NewPage->xlp_rem_len = 0; */ /* done by memset */
2150
2151 /*
2152 * If first page of an XLOG segment file, make it a long header.
2153 */
2154 if ((XLogSegmentOffset(NewPage->xlp_pageaddr, wal_segment_size)) == 0)
2155 {
2157
2159 NewLongPage->xlp_seg_size = wal_segment_size;
2160 NewLongPage->xlp_xlog_blcksz = XLOG_BLCKSZ;
2161 NewPage->xlp_info |= XLP_LONG_HEADER;
2162 }
2163
2164 /*
2165 * Make sure the initialization of the page becomes visible to others
2166 * before the xlblocks update. GetXLogBuffer() reads xlblocks without
2167 * holding a lock.
2168 */
2170
2173
2174 npages++;
2175 }
2177
2178#ifdef WAL_DEBUG
2179 if (XLOG_DEBUG && npages > 0)
2180 {
2181 elog(DEBUG1, "initialized %d pages, up to %X/%08X",
2183 }
2184#endif
2185}
2186
2187/*
2188 * Calculate CheckPointSegments based on max_wal_size_mb and
2189 * checkpoint_completion_target.
2190 */
2191static void
2193{
2194 double target;
2195
2196 /*-------
2197 * Calculate the distance at which to trigger a checkpoint, to avoid
2198 * exceeding max_wal_size_mb. This is based on two assumptions:
2199 *
2200 * a) we keep WAL for only one checkpoint cycle (prior to PG11 we kept
2201 * WAL for two checkpoint cycles to allow us to recover from the
2202 * secondary checkpoint if the first checkpoint failed, though we
2203 * only did this on the primary anyway, not on standby. Keeping just
2204 * one checkpoint simplifies processing and reduces disk space in
2205 * many smaller databases.)
2206 * b) during checkpoint, we consume checkpoint_completion_target *
2207 * number of segments consumed between checkpoints.
2208 *-------
2209 */
2212
2213 /* round down */
2214 CheckPointSegments = (int) target;
2215
2216 if (CheckPointSegments < 1)
2218}
2219
2220void
2226
2227void
2233
2234bool
2236{
2238 {
2239 GUC_check_errdetail("The WAL segment size must be a power of two between 1 MB and 1 GB.");
2240 return false;
2241 }
2242
2243 return true;
2244}
2245
2246/*
2247 * At a checkpoint, how many WAL segments to recycle as preallocated future
2248 * XLOG segments? Returns the highest segment that should be preallocated.
2249 */
2250static XLogSegNo
2252{
2255 double distance;
2257
2258 /*
2259 * Calculate the segment numbers that min_wal_size_mb and max_wal_size_mb
2260 * correspond to. Always recycle enough segments to meet the minimum, and
2261 * remove enough segments to stay below the maximum.
2262 */
2267
2268 /*
2269 * Between those limits, recycle enough segments to get us through to the
2270 * estimated end of next checkpoint.
2271 *
2272 * To estimate where the next checkpoint will finish, assume that the
2273 * system runs steadily consuming CheckPointDistanceEstimate bytes between
2274 * every checkpoint.
2275 */
2277 /* add 10% for good measure. */
2278 distance *= 1.10;
2279
2280 recycleSegNo = (XLogSegNo) ceil(((double) lastredoptr + distance) /
2282
2283 if (recycleSegNo < minSegNo)
2285 if (recycleSegNo > maxSegNo)
2287
2288 return recycleSegNo;
2289}
2290
2291/*
2292 * Check whether we've consumed enough xlog space that a checkpoint is needed.
2293 *
2294 * new_segno indicates a log file that has just been filled up (or read
2295 * during recovery). We measure the distance from RedoRecPtr to new_segno
2296 * and see if that exceeds CheckPointSegments.
2297 *
2298 * Note: it is caller's responsibility that RedoRecPtr is up-to-date.
2299 */
2300bool
2302{
2304
2306
2308 return true;
2309 return false;
2310}
2311
2312/*
2313 * Write and/or fsync the log at least as far as WriteRqst indicates.
2314 *
2315 * If flexible == true, we don't have to write as far as WriteRqst, but
2316 * may stop at any convenient boundary (such as a cache or logfile boundary).
2317 * This option allows us to avoid uselessly issuing multiple writes when a
2318 * single one would do.
2319 *
2320 * Must be called with WALWriteLock held. WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish(WriteRqst)
2321 * must be called before grabbing the lock, to make sure the data is ready to
2322 * write.
2323 */
2324static void
2326{
2327 bool ispartialpage;
2328 bool last_iteration;
2329 bool finishing_seg;
2330 int curridx;
2331 int npages;
2332 int startidx;
2334
2335 /* We should always be inside a critical section here */
2337
2338 /*
2339 * Update local LogwrtResult (caller probably did this already, but...)
2340 */
2342
2343 /*
2344 * Since successive pages in the xlog cache are consecutively allocated,
2345 * we can usually gather multiple pages together and issue just one
2346 * write() call. npages is the number of pages we have determined can be
2347 * written together; startidx is the cache block index of the first one,
2348 * and startoffset is the file offset at which it should go. The latter
2349 * two variables are only valid when npages > 0, but we must initialize
2350 * all of them to keep the compiler quiet.
2351 */
2352 npages = 0;
2353 startidx = 0;
2354 startoffset = 0;
2355
2356 /*
2357 * Within the loop, curridx is the cache block index of the page to
2358 * consider writing. Begin at the buffer containing the next unwritten
2359 * page, or last partially written page.
2360 */
2362
2363 while (LogwrtResult.Write < WriteRqst.Write)
2364 {
2365 /*
2366 * Make sure we're not ahead of the insert process. This could happen
2367 * if we're passed a bogus WriteRqst.Write that is past the end of the
2368 * last page that's been initialized by AdvanceXLInsertBuffer.
2369 */
2371
2372 if (LogwrtResult.Write >= EndPtr)
2373 elog(PANIC, "xlog write request %X/%08X is past end of log %X/%08X",
2376
2377 /* Advance LogwrtResult.Write to end of current buffer page */
2380
2383 {
2384 /*
2385 * Switch to new logfile segment. We cannot have any pending
2386 * pages here (since we dump what we have at segment end).
2387 */
2388 Assert(npages == 0);
2389 if (openLogFile >= 0)
2390 XLogFileClose();
2393 openLogTLI = tli;
2394
2395 /* create/use new log file */
2398 }
2399
2400 /* Make sure we have the current logfile open */
2401 if (openLogFile < 0)
2402 {
2405 openLogTLI = tli;
2408 }
2409
2410 /* Add current page to the set of pending pages-to-dump */
2411 if (npages == 0)
2412 {
2413 /* first of group */
2414 startidx = curridx;
2417 }
2418 npages++;
2419
2420 /*
2421 * Dump the set if this will be the last loop iteration, or if we are
2422 * at the last page of the cache area (since the next page won't be
2423 * contiguous in memory), or if we are at the end of the logfile
2424 * segment.
2425 */
2427
2430
2431 if (last_iteration ||
2434 {
2435 char *from;
2436 Size nbytes;
2437 Size nleft;
2440
2441 /* OK to write the page(s) */
2442 from = XLogCtl->pages + startidx * (Size) XLOG_BLCKSZ;
2443 nbytes = npages * (Size) XLOG_BLCKSZ;
2444 nleft = nbytes;
2445 do
2446 {
2447 errno = 0;
2448
2449 /*
2450 * Measure I/O timing to write WAL data, for pg_stat_io.
2451 */
2453
2457
2459 IOOP_WRITE, start, 1, written);
2460
2461 if (written <= 0)
2462 {
2463 char xlogfname[MAXFNAMELEN];
2464 int save_errno;
2465
2466 if (errno == EINTR)
2467 continue;
2468
2469 save_errno = errno;
2472 errno = save_errno;
2473 ereport(PANIC,
2475 errmsg("could not write to log file \"%s\" at offset %u, length %zu: %m",
2477 }
2478 nleft -= written;
2479 from += written;
2481 } while (nleft > 0);
2482
2483 npages = 0;
2484
2485 /*
2486 * If we just wrote the whole last page of a logfile segment,
2487 * fsync the segment immediately. This avoids having to go back
2488 * and re-open prior segments when an fsync request comes along
2489 * later. Doing it here ensures that one and only one backend will
2490 * perform this fsync.
2491 *
2492 * This is also the right place to notify the Archiver that the
2493 * segment is ready to copy to archival storage, and to update the
2494 * timer for archive_timeout, and to signal for a checkpoint if
2495 * too many logfile segments have been used since the last
2496 * checkpoint.
2497 */
2498 if (finishing_seg)
2499 {
2501
2502 /* signal that we need to wakeup walsenders later */
2504
2505 LogwrtResult.Flush = LogwrtResult.Write; /* end of page */
2506
2507 if (XLogArchivingActive())
2509
2512
2513 /*
2514 * Request a checkpoint if we've consumed too much xlog since
2515 * the last one. For speed, we first check using the local
2516 * copy of RedoRecPtr, which might be out of date; if it looks
2517 * like a checkpoint is needed, forcibly update RedoRecPtr and
2518 * recheck.
2519 */
2521 {
2522 (void) GetRedoRecPtr();
2525 }
2526 }
2527 }
2528
2529 if (ispartialpage)
2530 {
2531 /* Only asked to write a partial page */
2533 break;
2534 }
2536
2537 /* If flexible, break out of loop as soon as we wrote something */
2538 if (flexible && npages == 0)
2539 break;
2540 }
2541
2542 Assert(npages == 0);
2543
2544 /*
2545 * If asked to flush, do so
2546 */
2547 if (LogwrtResult.Flush < WriteRqst.Flush &&
2549 {
2550 /*
2551 * Could get here without iterating above loop, in which case we might
2552 * have no open file or the wrong one. However, we do not need to
2553 * fsync more than one file.
2554 */
2557 {
2558 if (openLogFile >= 0 &&
2561 XLogFileClose();
2562 if (openLogFile < 0)
2563 {
2566 openLogTLI = tli;
2569 }
2570
2572 }
2573
2574 /* signal that we need to wakeup walsenders later */
2576
2578 }
2579
2580 /*
2581 * Update shared-memory status
2582 *
2583 * We make sure that the shared 'request' values do not fall behind the
2584 * 'result' values. This is not absolutely essential, but it saves some
2585 * code in a couple of places.
2586 */
2593
2594 /*
2595 * We write Write first, bar, then Flush. When reading, the opposite must
2596 * be done (with a matching barrier in between), so that we always see a
2597 * Flush value that trails behind the Write value seen.
2598 */
2602
2603#ifdef USE_ASSERT_CHECKING
2604 {
2608
2614
2615 /* WAL written to disk is always ahead of WAL flushed */
2616 Assert(Write >= Flush);
2617
2618 /* WAL inserted to buffers is always ahead of WAL written */
2619 Assert(Insert >= Write);
2620 }
2621#endif
2622}
2623
2624/*
2625 * Record the LSN for an asynchronous transaction commit/abort
2626 * and nudge the WALWriter if there is work for it to do.
2627 * (This should not be called for synchronous commits.)
2628 */
2629void
2631{
2632 XLogRecPtr WriteRqstPtr = asyncXactLSN;
2633 bool sleeping;
2634 bool wakeup = false;
2636
2640 if (XLogCtl->asyncXactLSN < asyncXactLSN)
2641 XLogCtl->asyncXactLSN = asyncXactLSN;
2643
2644 /*
2645 * If somebody else already called this function with a more aggressive
2646 * LSN, they will have done what we needed (and perhaps more).
2647 */
2648 if (asyncXactLSN <= prevAsyncXactLSN)
2649 return;
2650
2651 /*
2652 * If the WALWriter is sleeping, kick it to make it come out of low-power
2653 * mode, so that this async commit will reach disk within the expected
2654 * amount of time. Otherwise, determine whether it has enough WAL
2655 * available to flush, the same way that XLogBackgroundFlush() does.
2656 */
2657 if (sleeping)
2658 wakeup = true;
2659 else
2660 {
2661 int flushblocks;
2662
2664
2665 flushblocks =
2667
2669 wakeup = true;
2670 }
2671
2672 if (wakeup)
2673 {
2674 volatile PROC_HDR *procglobal = ProcGlobal;
2675 ProcNumber walwriterProc = procglobal->walwriterProc;
2676
2677 if (walwriterProc != INVALID_PROC_NUMBER)
2678 SetLatch(&GetPGProcByNumber(walwriterProc)->procLatch);
2679 }
2680}
2681
2682/*
2683 * Record the LSN up to which we can remove WAL because it's not required by
2684 * any replication slot.
2685 */
2686void
2693
2694
2695/*
2696 * Return the oldest LSN we must retain to satisfy the needs of some
2697 * replication slot.
2698 */
2701{
2702 XLogRecPtr retval;
2703
2707
2708 return retval;
2709}
2710
2711/*
2712 * Advance minRecoveryPoint in control file.
2713 *
2714 * If we crash during recovery, we must reach this point again before the
2715 * database is consistent.
2716 *
2717 * If 'force' is true, 'lsn' argument is ignored. Otherwise, minRecoveryPoint
2718 * is only updated if it's not already greater than or equal to 'lsn'.
2719 */
2720static void
2722{
2723 /* Quick check using our local copy of the variable */
2724 if (!updateMinRecoveryPoint || (!force && lsn <= LocalMinRecoveryPoint))
2725 return;
2726
2727 /*
2728 * An invalid minRecoveryPoint means that we need to recover all the WAL,
2729 * i.e., we're doing crash recovery. We never modify the control file's
2730 * value in that case, so we can short-circuit future checks here too. The
2731 * local values of minRecoveryPoint and minRecoveryPointTLI should not be
2732 * updated until crash recovery finishes. We only do this for the startup
2733 * process as it should not update its own reference of minRecoveryPoint
2734 * until it has finished crash recovery to make sure that all WAL
2735 * available is replayed in this case. This also saves from extra locks
2736 * taken on the control file from the startup process.
2737 */
2739 {
2740 updateMinRecoveryPoint = false;
2741 return;
2742 }
2743
2745
2746 /* update local copy */
2749
2751 updateMinRecoveryPoint = false;
2752 else if (force || LocalMinRecoveryPoint < lsn)
2753 {
2756
2757 /*
2758 * To avoid having to update the control file too often, we update it
2759 * all the way to the last record being replayed, even though 'lsn'
2760 * would suffice for correctness. This also allows the 'force' case
2761 * to not need a valid 'lsn' value.
2762 *
2763 * Another important reason for doing it this way is that the passed
2764 * 'lsn' value could be bogus, i.e., past the end of available WAL, if
2765 * the caller got it from a corrupted heap page. Accepting such a
2766 * value as the min recovery point would prevent us from coming up at
2767 * all. Instead, we just log a warning and continue with recovery.
2768 * (See also the comments about corrupt LSNs in XLogFlush.)
2769 */
2771 if (!force && newMinRecoveryPoint < lsn)
2772 elog(WARNING,
2773 "xlog min recovery request %X/%08X is past current point %X/%08X",
2775
2776 /* update control file */
2778 {
2784
2786 errmsg_internal("updated min recovery point to %X/%08X on timeline %u",
2789 }
2790 }
2792}
2793
2794/*
2795 * Ensure that all XLOG data through the given position is flushed to disk.
2796 *
2797 * NOTE: this differs from XLogWrite mainly in that the WALWriteLock is not
2798 * already held, and we try to avoid acquiring it if possible.
2799 */
2800void
2802{
2806
2807 /*
2808 * During REDO, we are reading not writing WAL. Therefore, instead of
2809 * trying to flush the WAL, we should update minRecoveryPoint instead. We
2810 * test XLogInsertAllowed(), not InRecovery, because we need checkpointer
2811 * to act this way too, and because when it tries to write the
2812 * end-of-recovery checkpoint, it should indeed flush.
2813 */
2814 if (!XLogInsertAllowed())
2815 {
2816 UpdateMinRecoveryPoint(record, false);
2817 return;
2818 }
2819
2820 /* Quick exit if already known flushed */
2821 if (record <= LogwrtResult.Flush)
2822 return;
2823
2824#ifdef WAL_DEBUG
2825 if (XLOG_DEBUG)
2826 elog(LOG, "xlog flush request %X/%08X; write %X/%08X; flush %X/%08X",
2827 LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(record),
2830#endif
2831
2833
2834 /*
2835 * Since fsync is usually a horribly expensive operation, we try to
2836 * piggyback as much data as we can on each fsync: if we see any more data
2837 * entered into the xlog buffer, we'll write and fsync that too, so that
2838 * the final value of LogwrtResult.Flush is as large as possible. This
2839 * gives us some chance of avoiding another fsync immediately after.
2840 */
2841
2842 /* initialize to given target; may increase below */
2843 WriteRqstPtr = record;
2844
2845 /*
2846 * Now wait until we get the write lock, or someone else does the flush
2847 * for us.
2848 */
2849 for (;;)
2850 {
2852
2853 /* done already? */
2855 if (record <= LogwrtResult.Flush)
2856 break;
2857
2858 /*
2859 * Before actually performing the write, wait for all in-flight
2860 * insertions to the pages we're about to write to finish.
2861 */
2863 if (WriteRqstPtr < XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst.Write)
2867
2868 /*
2869 * Try to get the write lock. If we can't get it immediately, wait
2870 * until it's released, and recheck if we still need to do the flush
2871 * or if the backend that held the lock did it for us already. This
2872 * helps to maintain a good rate of group committing when the system
2873 * is bottlenecked by the speed of fsyncing.
2874 */
2876 {
2877 /*
2878 * The lock is now free, but we didn't acquire it yet. Before we
2879 * do, loop back to check if someone else flushed the record for
2880 * us already.
2881 */
2882 continue;
2883 }
2884
2885 /* Got the lock; recheck whether request is satisfied */
2887 if (record <= LogwrtResult.Flush)
2888 {
2890 break;
2891 }
2892
2893 /*
2894 * Sleep before flush! By adding a delay here, we may give further
2895 * backends the opportunity to join the backlog of group commit
2896 * followers; this can significantly improve transaction throughput,
2897 * at the risk of increasing transaction latency.
2898 *
2899 * We do not sleep if enableFsync is not turned on, nor if there are
2900 * fewer than CommitSiblings other backends with active transactions.
2901 */
2902 if (CommitDelay > 0 && enableFsync &&
2904 {
2908
2909 /*
2910 * Re-check how far we can now flush the WAL. It's generally not
2911 * safe to call WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish while holding
2912 * WALWriteLock, because an in-progress insertion might need to
2913 * also grab WALWriteLock to make progress. But we know that all
2914 * the insertions up to insertpos have already finished, because
2915 * that's what the earlier WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish() returned.
2916 * We're only calling it again to allow insertpos to be moved
2917 * further forward, not to actually wait for anyone.
2918 */
2920 }
2921
2922 /* try to write/flush later additions to XLOG as well */
2923 WriteRqst.Write = insertpos;
2924 WriteRqst.Flush = insertpos;
2925
2926 XLogWrite(WriteRqst, insertTLI, false);
2927
2929 /* done */
2930 break;
2931 }
2932
2934
2935 /* wake up walsenders now that we've released heavily contended locks */
2937
2938 /*
2939 * Wake up processes waiting for primary flush LSN to reach current flush
2940 * position.
2941 */
2943
2944 /*
2945 * If we still haven't flushed to the request point then we have a
2946 * problem; most likely, the requested flush point is past end of XLOG.
2947 * This has been seen to occur when a disk page has a corrupted LSN.
2948 *
2949 * Formerly we treated this as a PANIC condition, but that hurts the
2950 * system's robustness rather than helping it: we do not want to take down
2951 * the whole system due to corruption on one data page. In particular, if
2952 * the bad page is encountered again during recovery then we would be
2953 * unable to restart the database at all! (This scenario actually
2954 * happened in the field several times with 7.1 releases.) As of 8.4, bad
2955 * LSNs encountered during recovery are UpdateMinRecoveryPoint's problem;
2956 * the only time we can reach here during recovery is while flushing the
2957 * end-of-recovery checkpoint record, and we don't expect that to have a
2958 * bad LSN.
2959 *
2960 * Note that for calls from xact.c, the ERROR will be promoted to PANIC
2961 * since xact.c calls this routine inside a critical section. However,
2962 * calls from bufmgr.c are not within critical sections and so we will not
2963 * force a restart for a bad LSN on a data page.
2964 */
2965 if (LogwrtResult.Flush < record)
2966 elog(ERROR,
2967 "xlog flush request %X/%08X is not satisfied --- flushed only to %X/%08X",
2968 LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(record),
2970
2971 /*
2972 * Cross-check XLogNeedsFlush(). Some of the checks of XLogFlush() and
2973 * XLogNeedsFlush() are duplicated, and this assertion ensures that these
2974 * remain consistent.
2975 */
2976 Assert(!XLogNeedsFlush(record));
2977}
2978
2979/*
2980 * Write & flush xlog, but without specifying exactly where to.
2981 *
2982 * We normally write only completed blocks; but if there is nothing to do on
2983 * that basis, we check for unwritten async commits in the current incomplete
2984 * block, and write through the latest one of those. Thus, if async commits
2985 * are not being used, we will write complete blocks only.
2986 *
2987 * If, based on the above, there's anything to write we do so immediately. But
2988 * to avoid calling fsync, fdatasync et. al. at a rate that'd impact
2989 * concurrent IO, we only flush WAL every wal_writer_delay ms, or if there's
2990 * more than wal_writer_flush_after unflushed blocks.
2991 *
2992 * We can guarantee that async commits reach disk after at most three
2993 * wal_writer_delay cycles. (When flushing complete blocks, we allow XLogWrite
2994 * to write "flexibly", meaning it can stop at the end of the buffer ring;
2995 * this makes a difference only with very high load or long wal_writer_delay,
2996 * but imposes one extra cycle for the worst case for async commits.)
2997 *
2998 * This routine is invoked periodically by the background walwriter process.
2999 *
3000 * Returns true if there was any work to do, even if we skipped flushing due
3001 * to wal_writer_delay/wal_writer_flush_after.
3002 */
3003bool
3005{
3007 bool flexible = true;
3008 static TimestampTz lastflush;
3010 int flushblocks;
3012
3013 /* XLOG doesn't need flushing during recovery */
3014 if (RecoveryInProgress())
3015 return false;
3016
3017 /*
3018 * Since we're not in recovery, InsertTimeLineID is set and can't change,
3019 * so we can read it without a lock.
3020 */
3022
3023 /* read updated LogwrtRqst */
3027
3028 /* back off to last completed page boundary */
3029 WriteRqst.Write -= WriteRqst.Write % XLOG_BLCKSZ;
3030
3031 /* if we have already flushed that far, consider async commit records */
3033 if (WriteRqst.Write <= LogwrtResult.Flush)
3034 {
3038 flexible = false; /* ensure it all gets written */
3039 }
3040
3041 /*
3042 * If already known flushed, we're done. Just need to check if we are
3043 * holding an open file handle to a logfile that's no longer in use,
3044 * preventing the file from being deleted.
3045 */
3046 if (WriteRqst.Write <= LogwrtResult.Flush)
3047 {
3048 if (openLogFile >= 0)
3049 {
3052 {
3053 XLogFileClose();
3054 }
3055 }
3056 return false;
3057 }
3058
3059 /*
3060 * Determine how far to flush WAL, based on the wal_writer_delay and
3061 * wal_writer_flush_after GUCs.
3062 *
3063 * Note that XLogSetAsyncXactLSN() performs similar calculation based on
3064 * wal_writer_flush_after, to decide when to wake us up. Make sure the
3065 * logic is the same in both places if you change this.
3066 */
3068 flushblocks =
3070
3071 if (WalWriterFlushAfter == 0 || lastflush == 0)
3072 {
3073 /* first call, or block based limits disabled */
3074 WriteRqst.Flush = WriteRqst.Write;
3075 lastflush = now;
3076 }
3078 {
3079 /*
3080 * Flush the writes at least every WalWriterDelay ms. This is
3081 * important to bound the amount of time it takes for an asynchronous
3082 * commit to hit disk.
3083 */
3084 WriteRqst.Flush = WriteRqst.Write;
3085 lastflush = now;
3086 }
3087 else if (flushblocks >= WalWriterFlushAfter)
3088 {
3089 /* exceeded wal_writer_flush_after blocks, flush */
3090 WriteRqst.Flush = WriteRqst.Write;
3091 lastflush = now;
3092 }
3093 else
3094 {
3095 /* no flushing, this time round */
3097 }
3098
3099#ifdef WAL_DEBUG
3100 if (XLOG_DEBUG)
3101 elog(LOG, "xlog bg flush request write %X/%08X; flush: %X/%08X, current is write %X/%08X; flush %X/%08X",
3106#endif
3107
3109
3110 /* now wait for any in-progress insertions to finish and get write lock */
3114 if (WriteRqst.Write > LogwrtResult.Write ||
3116 {
3118 }
3120
3122
3123 /* wake up walsenders now that we've released heavily contended locks */
3125
3126 /*
3127 * Wake up processes waiting for primary flush LSN to reach current flush
3128 * position.
3129 */
3131
3132 /*
3133 * Great, done. To take some work off the critical path, try to initialize
3134 * as many of the no-longer-needed WAL buffers for future use as we can.
3135 */
3137
3138 /*
3139 * If we determined that we need to write data, but somebody else
3140 * wrote/flushed already, it should be considered as being active, to
3141 * avoid hibernating too early.
3142 */
3143 return true;
3144}
3145
3146/*
3147 * Test whether XLOG data has been flushed up to (at least) the given
3148 * position, or whether the minimum recovery point has been updated past
3149 * the given position.
3150 *
3151 * Returns true if a flush is still needed, or if the minimum recovery point
3152 * must be updated.
3153 *
3154 * It is possible that someone else is already in the process of flushing
3155 * that far, or has updated the minimum recovery point up to the given
3156 * position.
3157 */
3158bool
3160{
3161 /*
3162 * During recovery, we don't flush WAL but update minRecoveryPoint
3163 * instead. So "needs flush" is taken to mean whether minRecoveryPoint
3164 * would need to be updated.
3165 *
3166 * Using XLogInsertAllowed() rather than RecoveryInProgress() matters for
3167 * the case of an end-of-recovery checkpoint, where WAL data is flushed.
3168 * This check should be consistent with the one in XLogFlush().
3169 */
3170 if (!XLogInsertAllowed())
3171 {
3172 /* Quick exit if already known to be updated or cannot be updated */
3174 return false;
3175
3176 /*
3177 * An invalid minRecoveryPoint means that we need to recover all the
3178 * WAL, i.e., we're doing crash recovery. We never modify the control
3179 * file's value in that case, so we can short-circuit future checks
3180 * here too. This triggers a quick exit path for the startup process,
3181 * which cannot update its local copy of minRecoveryPoint as long as
3182 * it has not replayed all WAL available when doing crash recovery.
3183 */
3185 {
3186 updateMinRecoveryPoint = false;
3187 return false;
3188 }
3189
3190 /*
3191 * Update local copy of minRecoveryPoint. But if the lock is busy,
3192 * just return a conservative guess.
3193 */
3195 return true;
3199
3200 /*
3201 * Check minRecoveryPoint for any other process than the startup
3202 * process doing crash recovery, which should not update the control
3203 * file value if crash recovery is still running.
3204 */
3206 updateMinRecoveryPoint = false;
3207
3208 /* check again */
3210 return false;
3211 else
3212 return true;
3213 }
3214
3215 /* Quick exit if already known flushed */
3216 if (record <= LogwrtResult.Flush)
3217 return false;
3218
3219 /* read LogwrtResult and update local state */
3221
3222 /* check again */
3223 if (record <= LogwrtResult.Flush)
3224 return false;
3225
3226 return true;
3227}
3228
3229/*
3230 * Try to make a given XLOG file segment exist.
3231 *
3232 * logsegno: identify segment.
3233 *
3234 * *added: on return, true if this call raised the number of extant segments.
3235 *
3236 * path: on return, this char[MAXPGPATH] has the path to the logsegno file.
3237 *
3238 * Returns -1 or FD of opened file. A -1 here is not an error; a caller
3239 * wanting an open segment should attempt to open "path", which usually will
3240 * succeed. (This is weird, but it's efficient for the callers.)
3241 */
3242static int
3244 bool *added, char *path)
3245{
3246 char tmppath[MAXPGPATH];
3249 int fd;
3250 int save_errno;
3253
3254 Assert(logtli != 0);
3255
3257
3258 /*
3259 * Try to use existent file (checkpoint maker may have created it already)
3260 */
3261 *added = false;
3264 if (fd < 0)
3265 {
3266 if (errno != ENOENT)
3267 ereport(ERROR,
3269 errmsg("could not open file \"%s\": %m", path)));
3270 }
3271 else
3272 return fd;
3273
3274 /*
3275 * Initialize an empty (all zeroes) segment. NOTE: it is possible that
3276 * another process is doing the same thing. If so, we will end up
3277 * pre-creating an extra log segment. That seems OK, and better than
3278 * holding the lock throughout this lengthy process.
3279 */
3280 elog(DEBUG2, "creating and filling new WAL file");
3281
3282 snprintf(tmppath, MAXPGPATH, XLOGDIR "/xlogtemp.%d", (int) getpid());
3283
3284 unlink(tmppath);
3285
3288
3289 /* do not use get_sync_bit() here --- want to fsync only at end of fill */
3291 if (fd < 0)
3292 ereport(ERROR,
3294 errmsg("could not create file \"%s\": %m", tmppath)));
3295
3296 /* Measure I/O timing when initializing segment */
3298
3300 save_errno = 0;
3301 if (wal_init_zero)
3302 {
3303 ssize_t rc;
3304
3305 /*
3306 * Zero-fill the file. With this setting, we do this the hard way to
3307 * ensure that all the file space has really been allocated. On
3308 * platforms that allow "holes" in files, just seeking to the end
3309 * doesn't allocate intermediate space. This way, we know that we
3310 * have all the space and (after the fsync below) that all the
3311 * indirect blocks are down on disk. Therefore, fdatasync(2) or
3312 * O_DSYNC will be sufficient to sync future writes to the log file.
3313 */
3315
3316 if (rc < 0)
3317 save_errno = errno;
3318 }
3319 else
3320 {
3321 /*
3322 * Otherwise, seeking to the end and writing a solitary byte is
3323 * enough.
3324 */
3325 errno = 0;
3326 if (pg_pwrite(fd, "\0", 1, wal_segment_size - 1) != 1)
3327 {
3328 /* if write didn't set errno, assume no disk space */
3330 }
3331 }
3333
3334 /*
3335 * A full segment worth of data is written when using wal_init_zero. One
3336 * byte is written when not using it.
3337 */
3339 io_start, 1,
3341
3342 if (save_errno)
3343 {
3344 /*
3345 * If we fail to make the file, delete it to release disk space
3346 */
3347 unlink(tmppath);
3348
3349 close(fd);
3350
3351 errno = save_errno;
3352
3353 ereport(ERROR,
3355 errmsg("could not write to file \"%s\": %m", tmppath)));
3356 }
3357
3358 /* Measure I/O timing when flushing segment */
3360
3362 if (pg_fsync(fd) != 0)
3363 {
3364 save_errno = errno;
3365 close(fd);
3366 errno = save_errno;
3367 ereport(ERROR,
3369 errmsg("could not fsync file \"%s\": %m", tmppath)));
3370 }
3372
3374 IOOP_FSYNC, io_start, 1, 0);
3375
3376 if (close(fd) != 0)
3377 ereport(ERROR,
3379 errmsg("could not close file \"%s\": %m", tmppath)));
3380
3381 /*
3382 * Now move the segment into place with its final name. Cope with
3383 * possibility that someone else has created the file while we were
3384 * filling ours: if so, use ours to pre-create a future log segment.
3385 */
3387
3388 /*
3389 * XXX: What should we use as max_segno? We used to use XLOGfileslop when
3390 * that was a constant, but that was always a bit dubious: normally, at a
3391 * checkpoint, XLOGfileslop was the offset from the checkpoint record, but
3392 * here, it was the offset from the insert location. We can't do the
3393 * normal XLOGfileslop calculation here because we don't have access to
3394 * the prior checkpoint's redo location. So somewhat arbitrarily, just use
3395 * CheckPointSegments.
3396 */
3399 logtli))
3400 {
3401 *added = true;
3402 elog(DEBUG2, "done creating and filling new WAL file");
3403 }
3404 else
3405 {
3406 /*
3407 * No need for any more future segments, or InstallXLogFileSegment()
3408 * failed to rename the file into place. If the rename failed, a
3409 * caller opening the file may fail.
3410 */
3411 unlink(tmppath);
3412 elog(DEBUG2, "abandoned new WAL file");
3413 }
3414
3415 return -1;
3416}
3417
3418/*
3419 * Create a new XLOG file segment, or open a pre-existing one.
3420 *
3421 * logsegno: identify segment to be created/opened.
3422 *
3423 * Returns FD of opened file.
3424 *
3425 * Note: errors here are ERROR not PANIC because we might or might not be
3426 * inside a critical section (eg, during checkpoint there is no reason to
3427 * take down the system on failure). They will promote to PANIC if we are
3428 * in a critical section.
3429 */
3430int
3432{
3433 bool ignore_added;
3434 char path[MAXPGPATH];
3435 int fd;
3436
3437 Assert(logtli != 0);
3438
3440 if (fd >= 0)
3441 return fd;
3442
3443 /* Now open original target segment (might not be file I just made) */
3446 if (fd < 0)
3447 ereport(ERROR,
3449 errmsg("could not open file \"%s\": %m", path)));
3450 return fd;
3451}
3452
3453/*
3454 * Create a new XLOG file segment by copying a pre-existing one.
3455 *
3456 * destsegno: identify segment to be created.
3457 *
3458 * srcTLI, srcsegno: identify segment to be copied (could be from
3459 * a different timeline)
3460 *
3461 * upto: how much of the source file to copy (the rest is filled with
3462 * zeros)
3463 *
3464 * Currently this is only used during recovery, and so there are no locking
3465 * considerations. But we should be just as tense as XLogFileInit to avoid
3466 * emplacing a bogus file.
3467 */
3468static void
3471 int upto)
3472{
3473 char path[MAXPGPATH];
3474 char tmppath[MAXPGPATH];
3475 PGAlignedXLogBlock buffer;
3476 int srcfd;
3477 int fd;
3478 int nbytes;
3479
3480 /*
3481 * Open the source file
3482 */
3485 if (srcfd < 0)
3486 ereport(ERROR,
3488 errmsg("could not open file \"%s\": %m", path)));
3489
3490 /*
3491 * Copy into a temp file name.
3492 */
3493 snprintf(tmppath, MAXPGPATH, XLOGDIR "/xlogtemp.%d", (int) getpid());
3494
3495 unlink(tmppath);
3496
3497 /* do not use get_sync_bit() here --- want to fsync only at end of fill */
3499 if (fd < 0)
3500 ereport(ERROR,
3502 errmsg("could not create file \"%s\": %m", tmppath)));
3503
3504 /*
3505 * Do the data copying.
3506 */
3507 for (nbytes = 0; nbytes < wal_segment_size; nbytes += sizeof(buffer))
3508 {
3509 int nread;
3510
3511 nread = upto - nbytes;
3512
3513 /*
3514 * The part that is not read from the source file is filled with
3515 * zeros.
3516 */
3517 if (nread < sizeof(buffer))
3518 memset(buffer.data, 0, sizeof(buffer));
3519
3520 if (nread > 0)
3521 {
3522 int r;
3523
3524 if (nread > sizeof(buffer))
3525 nread = sizeof(buffer);
3527 r = read(srcfd, buffer.data, nread);
3528 if (r != nread)
3529 {
3530 if (r < 0)
3531 ereport(ERROR,
3533 errmsg("could not read file \"%s\": %m",
3534 path)));
3535 else
3536 ereport(ERROR,
3538 errmsg("could not read file \"%s\": read %d of %zu",
3539 path, r, (Size) nread)));
3540 }
3542 }
3543 errno = 0;
3545 if ((int) write(fd, buffer.data, sizeof(buffer)) != (int) sizeof(buffer))
3546 {
3547 int save_errno = errno;
3548
3549 /*
3550 * If we fail to make the file, delete it to release disk space
3551 */
3552 unlink(tmppath);
3553 /* if write didn't set errno, assume problem is no disk space */
3555
3556 ereport(ERROR,
3558 errmsg("could not write to file \"%s\": %m", tmppath)));
3559 }
3561 }
3562
3564 if (pg_fsync(fd) != 0)
3567 errmsg("could not fsync file \"%s\": %m", tmppath)));
3569
3570 if (CloseTransientFile(fd) != 0)
3571 ereport(ERROR,
3573 errmsg("could not close file \"%s\": %m", tmppath)));
3574
3575 if (CloseTransientFile(srcfd) != 0)
3576 ereport(ERROR,
3578 errmsg("could not close file \"%s\": %m", path)));
3579
3580 /*
3581 * Now move the segment into place with its final name.
3582 */
3584 elog(ERROR, "InstallXLogFileSegment should not have failed");
3585}
3586
3587/*
3588 * Install a new XLOG segment file as a current or future log segment.
3589 *
3590 * This is used both to install a newly-created segment (which has a temp
3591 * filename while it's being created) and to recycle an old segment.
3592 *
3593 * *segno: identify segment to install as (or first possible target).
3594 * When find_free is true, this is modified on return to indicate the
3595 * actual installation location or last segment searched.
3596 *
3597 * tmppath: initial name of file to install. It will be renamed into place.
3598 *
3599 * find_free: if true, install the new segment at the first empty segno
3600 * number at or after the passed numbers. If false, install the new segment
3601 * exactly where specified, deleting any existing segment file there.
3602 *
3603 * max_segno: maximum segment number to install the new file as. Fail if no
3604 * free slot is found between *segno and max_segno. (Ignored when find_free
3605 * is false.)
3606 *
3607 * tli: The timeline on which the new segment should be installed.
3608 *
3609 * Returns true if the file was installed successfully. false indicates that
3610 * max_segno limit was exceeded, the startup process has disabled this
3611 * function for now, or an error occurred while renaming the file into place.
3612 */
3613static bool
3616{
3617 char path[MAXPGPATH];
3618 struct stat stat_buf;
3619
3620 Assert(tli != 0);
3621
3622 XLogFilePath(path, tli, *segno, wal_segment_size);
3623
3626 {
3628 return false;
3629 }
3630
3631 if (!find_free)
3632 {
3633 /* Force installation: get rid of any pre-existing segment file */
3634 durable_unlink(path, DEBUG1);
3635 }
3636 else
3637 {
3638 /* Find a free slot to put it in */
3639 while (stat(path, &stat_buf) == 0)
3640 {
3641 if ((*segno) >= max_segno)
3642 {
3643 /* Failed to find a free slot within specified range */
3645 return false;
3646 }
3647 (*segno)++;
3648 XLogFilePath(path, tli, *segno, wal_segment_size);
3649 }
3650 }
3651
3652 Assert(access(path, F_OK) != 0 && errno == ENOENT);
3653 if (durable_rename(tmppath, path, LOG) != 0)
3654 {
3656 /* durable_rename already emitted log message */
3657 return false;
3658 }
3659
3661
3662 return true;
3663}
3664
3665/*
3666 * Open a pre-existing logfile segment for writing.
3667 */
3668int
3670{
3671 char path[MAXPGPATH];
3672 int fd;
3673
3674 XLogFilePath(path, tli, segno, wal_segment_size);
3675
3678 if (fd < 0)
3679 ereport(PANIC,
3681 errmsg("could not open file \"%s\": %m", path)));
3682
3683 return fd;
3684}
3685
3686/*
3687 * Close the current logfile segment for writing.
3688 */
3689static void
3691{
3692 Assert(openLogFile >= 0);
3693
3694 /*
3695 * WAL segment files will not be re-read in normal operation, so we advise
3696 * the OS to release any cached pages. But do not do so if WAL archiving
3697 * or streaming is active, because archiver and walsender process could
3698 * use the cache to read the WAL segment.
3699 */
3700#if defined(USE_POSIX_FADVISE) && defined(POSIX_FADV_DONTNEED)
3701 if (!XLogIsNeeded() && (io_direct_flags & IO_DIRECT_WAL) == 0)
3703#endif
3704
3705 if (close(openLogFile) != 0)
3706 {
3707 char xlogfname[MAXFNAMELEN];
3708 int save_errno = errno;
3709
3711 errno = save_errno;
3712 ereport(PANIC,
3714 errmsg("could not close file \"%s\": %m", xlogfname)));
3715 }
3716
3717 openLogFile = -1;
3719}
3720
3721/*
3722 * Preallocate log files beyond the specified log endpoint.
3723 *
3724 * XXX this is currently extremely conservative, since it forces only one
3725 * future log segment to exist, and even that only if we are 75% done with
3726 * the current one. This is only appropriate for very low-WAL-volume systems.
3727 * High-volume systems will be OK once they've built up a sufficient set of
3728 * recycled log segments, but the startup transient is likely to include
3729 * a lot of segment creations by foreground processes, which is not so good.
3730 *
3731 * XLogFileInitInternal() can ereport(ERROR). All known causes indicate big
3732 * trouble; for example, a full filesystem is one cause. The checkpoint WAL
3733 * and/or ControlFile updates already completed. If a RequestCheckpoint()
3734 * initiated the present checkpoint and an ERROR ends this function, the
3735 * command that called RequestCheckpoint() fails. That's not ideal, but it's
3736 * not worth contorting more functions to use caller-specified elevel values.
3737 * (With or without RequestCheckpoint(), an ERROR forestalls some inessential
3738 * reporting and resource reclamation.)
3739 */
3740static void
3742{
3744 int lf;
3745 bool added;
3746 char path[MAXPGPATH];
3747 uint64 offset;
3748
3750 return; /* unlocked check says no */
3751
3753 offset = XLogSegmentOffset(endptr - 1, wal_segment_size);
3754 if (offset >= (uint32) (0.75 * wal_segment_size))
3755 {
3756 _logSegNo++;
3757 lf = XLogFileInitInternal(_logSegNo, tli, &added, path);
3758 if (lf >= 0)
3759 close(lf);
3760 if (added)
3762 }
3763}
3764
3765/*
3766 * Throws an error if the given log segment has already been removed or
3767 * recycled. The caller should only pass a segment that it knows to have
3768 * existed while the server has been running, as this function always
3769 * succeeds if no WAL segments have been removed since startup.
3770 * 'tli' is only used in the error message.
3771 *
3772 * Note: this function guarantees to keep errno unchanged on return.
3773 * This supports callers that use this to possibly deliver a better
3774 * error message about a missing file, while still being able to throw
3775 * a normal file-access error afterwards, if this does return.
3776 */
3777void
3779{
3780 int save_errno = errno;
3781 XLogSegNo lastRemovedSegNo;
3782
3784 lastRemovedSegNo = XLogCtl->lastRemovedSegNo;
3786
3787 if (segno <= lastRemovedSegNo)
3788 {
3789 char filename[MAXFNAMELEN];
3790
3792 errno = save_errno;
3793 ereport(ERROR,
3795 errmsg("requested WAL segment %s has already been removed",
3796 filename)));
3797 }
3798 errno = save_errno;
3799}
3800
3801/*
3802 * Return the last WAL segment removed, or 0 if no segment has been removed
3803 * since startup.
3804 *
3805 * NB: the result can be out of date arbitrarily fast, the caller has to deal
3806 * with that.
3807 */
3810{
3811 XLogSegNo lastRemovedSegNo;
3812
3814 lastRemovedSegNo = XLogCtl->lastRemovedSegNo;
3816
3817 return lastRemovedSegNo;
3818}
3819
3820/*
3821 * Return the oldest WAL segment on the given TLI that still exists in
3822 * XLOGDIR, or 0 if none.
3823 */
3826{
3827 DIR *xldir;
3828 struct dirent *xlde;
3830
3832 while ((xlde = ReadDir(xldir, XLOGDIR)) != NULL)
3833 {
3836
3837 /* Ignore files that are not XLOG segments. */
3838 if (!IsXLogFileName(xlde->d_name))
3839 continue;
3840
3841 /* Parse filename to get TLI and segno. */
3844
3845 /* Ignore anything that's not from the TLI of interest. */
3846 if (tli != file_tli)
3847 continue;
3848
3849 /* If it's the oldest so far, update oldest_segno. */
3850 if (oldest_segno == 0 || file_segno < oldest_segno)
3852 }
3853
3854 FreeDir(xldir);
3855 return oldest_segno;
3856}
3857
3858/*
3859 * Update the last removed segno pointer in shared memory, to reflect that the
3860 * given XLOG file has been removed.
3861 */
3862static void
3864{
3865 uint32 tli;
3866 XLogSegNo segno;
3867
3869
3871 if (segno > XLogCtl->lastRemovedSegNo)
3872 XLogCtl->lastRemovedSegNo = segno;
3874}
3875
3876/*
3877 * Remove all temporary log files in pg_wal
3878 *
3879 * This is called at the beginning of recovery after a previous crash,
3880 * at a point where no other processes write fresh WAL data.
3881 */
3882static void
3884{
3885 DIR *xldir;
3886 struct dirent *xlde;
3887
3888 elog(DEBUG2, "removing all temporary WAL segments");
3889
3891 while ((xlde = ReadDir(xldir, XLOGDIR)) != NULL)
3892 {
3893 char path[MAXPGPATH];
3894
3895 if (strncmp(xlde->d_name, "xlogtemp.", 9) != 0)
3896 continue;
3897
3898 snprintf(path, MAXPGPATH, XLOGDIR "/%s", xlde->d_name);
3899 unlink(path);
3900 elog(DEBUG2, "removed temporary WAL segment \"%s\"", path);
3901 }
3902 FreeDir(xldir);
3903}
3904
3905/*
3906 * Recycle or remove all log files older or equal to passed segno.
3907 *
3908 * endptr is current (or recent) end of xlog, and lastredoptr is the
3909 * redo pointer of the last checkpoint. These are used to determine
3910 * whether we want to recycle rather than delete no-longer-wanted log files.
3911 *
3912 * insertTLI is the current timeline for XLOG insertion. Any recycled
3913 * segments should be reused for this timeline.
3914 */
3915static void
3918{
3919 DIR *xldir;
3920 struct dirent *xlde;
3921 char lastoff[MAXFNAMELEN];
3924
3925 /* Initialize info about where to try to recycle to */
3928
3929 /*
3930 * Construct a filename of the last segment to be kept. The timeline ID
3931 * doesn't matter, we ignore that in the comparison. (During recovery,
3932 * InsertTimeLineID isn't set, so we can't use that.)
3933 */
3935
3936 elog(DEBUG2, "attempting to remove WAL segments older than log file %s",
3937 lastoff);
3938
3940
3941 while ((xlde = ReadDir(xldir, XLOGDIR)) != NULL)
3942 {
3943 /* Ignore files that are not XLOG segments */
3944 if (!IsXLogFileName(xlde->d_name) &&
3945 !IsPartialXLogFileName(xlde->d_name))
3946 continue;
3947
3948 /*
3949 * We ignore the timeline part of the XLOG segment identifiers in
3950 * deciding whether a segment is still needed. This ensures that we
3951 * won't prematurely remove a segment from a parent timeline. We could
3952 * probably be a little more proactive about removing segments of
3953 * non-parent timelines, but that would be a whole lot more
3954 * complicated.
3955 *
3956 * We use the alphanumeric sorting property of the filenames to decide
3957 * which ones are earlier than the lastoff segment.
3958 */
3959 if (strcmp(xlde->d_name + 8, lastoff + 8) <= 0)
3960 {
3961 if (XLogArchiveCheckDone(xlde->d_name))
3962 {
3963 /* Update the last removed location in shared memory first */
3964 UpdateLastRemovedPtr(xlde->d_name);
3965
3967 }
3968 }
3969 }
3970
3971 FreeDir(xldir);
3972}
3973
3974/*
3975 * Recycle or remove WAL files that are not part of the given timeline's
3976 * history.
3977 *
3978 * This is called during recovery, whenever we switch to follow a new
3979 * timeline, and at the end of recovery when we create a new timeline. We
3980 * wouldn't otherwise care about extra WAL files lying in pg_wal, but they
3981 * might be leftover pre-allocated or recycled WAL segments on the old timeline
3982 * that we haven't used yet, and contain garbage. If we just leave them in
3983 * pg_wal, they will eventually be archived, and we can't let that happen.
3984 * Files that belong to our timeline history are valid, because we have
3985 * successfully replayed them, but from others we can't be sure.
3986 *
3987 * 'switchpoint' is the current point in WAL where we switch to new timeline,
3988 * and 'newTLI' is the new timeline we switch to.
3989 */
3990void
3992{
3993 DIR *xldir;
3994 struct dirent *xlde;
3995 char switchseg[MAXFNAMELEN];
3999
4000 /*
4001 * Initialize info about where to begin the work. This will recycle,
4002 * somewhat arbitrarily, 10 future segments.
4003 */
4007
4008 /*
4009 * Construct a filename of the last segment to be kept.
4010 */
4012
4013 elog(DEBUG2, "attempting to remove WAL segments newer than log file %s",
4014 switchseg);
4015
4017
4018 while ((xlde = ReadDir(xldir, XLOGDIR)) != NULL)
4019 {
4020 /* Ignore files that are not XLOG segments */
4021 if (!IsXLogFileName(xlde->d_name))
4022 continue;
4023
4024 /*
4025 * Remove files that are on a timeline older than the new one we're
4026 * switching to, but with a segment number >= the first segment on the
4027 * new timeline.
4028 */
4029 if (strncmp(xlde->d_name, switchseg, 8) < 0 &&
4030 strcmp(xlde->d_name + 8, switchseg + 8) > 0)
4031 {
4032 /*
4033 * If the file has already been marked as .ready, however, don't
4034 * remove it yet. It should be OK to remove it - files that are
4035 * not part of our timeline history are not required for recovery
4036 * - but seems safer to let them be archived and removed later.
4037 */
4038 if (!XLogArchiveIsReady(xlde->d_name))
4040 }
4041 }
4042
4043 FreeDir(xldir);
4044}
4045
4046/*
4047 * Recycle or remove a log file that's no longer needed.
4048 *
4049 * segment_de is the dirent structure of the segment to recycle or remove.
4050 * recycleSegNo is the segment number to recycle up to. endlogSegNo is
4051 * the segment number of the current (or recent) end of WAL.
4052 *
4053 * endlogSegNo gets incremented if the segment is recycled so as it is not
4054 * checked again with future callers of this function.
4055 *
4056 * insertTLI is the current timeline for XLOG insertion. Any recycled segments
4057 * should be used for this timeline.
4058 */
4059static void
4063{
4064 char path[MAXPGPATH];
4065#ifdef WIN32
4066 char newpath[MAXPGPATH];
4067#endif
4068 const char *segname = segment_de->d_name;
4069
4070 snprintf(path, MAXPGPATH, XLOGDIR "/%s", segname);
4071
4072 /*
4073 * Before deleting the file, see if it can be recycled as a future log
4074 * segment. Only recycle normal files, because we don't want to recycle
4075 * symbolic links pointing to a separate archive directory.
4076 */
4077 if (wal_recycle &&
4079 XLogCtl->InstallXLogFileSegmentActive && /* callee rechecks this */
4080 get_dirent_type(path, segment_de, false, DEBUG2) == PGFILETYPE_REG &&
4082 true, recycleSegNo, insertTLI))
4083 {
4085 (errmsg_internal("recycled write-ahead log file \"%s\"",
4086 segname)));
4088 /* Needn't recheck that slot on future iterations */
4089 (*endlogSegNo)++;
4090 }
4091 else
4092 {
4093 /* No need for any more future segments, or recycling failed ... */
4094 int rc;
4095
4097 (errmsg_internal("removing write-ahead log file \"%s\"",
4098 segname)));
4099
4100#ifdef WIN32
4101
4102 /*
4103 * On Windows, if another process (e.g another backend) holds the file
4104 * open in FILE_SHARE_DELETE mode, unlink will succeed, but the file
4105 * will still show up in directory listing until the last handle is
4106 * closed. To avoid confusing the lingering deleted file for a live
4107 * WAL file that needs to be archived, rename it before deleting it.
4108 *
4109 * If another process holds the file open without FILE_SHARE_DELETE
4110 * flag, rename will fail. We'll try again at the next checkpoint.
4111 */
4112 snprintf(newpath, MAXPGPATH, "%s.deleted", path);
4113 if (rename(path, newpath) != 0)
4114 {
4115 ereport(LOG,
4117 errmsg("could not rename file \"%s\": %m",
4118 path)));
4119 return;
4120 }
4121 rc = durable_unlink(newpath, LOG);
4122#else
4123 rc = durable_unlink(path, LOG);
4124#endif
4125 if (rc != 0)
4126 {
4127 /* Message already logged by durable_unlink() */
4128 return;
4129 }
4131 }
4132
4134}
4135
4136/*
4137 * Verify whether pg_wal, pg_wal/archive_status, and pg_wal/summaries exist.
4138 * If the latter do not exist, recreate them.
4139 *
4140 * It is not the goal of this function to verify the contents of these
4141 * directories, but to help in cases where someone has performed a cluster
4142 * copy for PITR purposes but omitted pg_wal from the copy.
4143 *
4144 * We could also recreate pg_wal if it doesn't exist, but a deliberate
4145 * policy decision was made not to. It is fairly common for pg_wal to be
4146 * a symlink, and if that was the DBA's intent then automatically making a
4147 * plain directory would result in degraded performance with no notice.
4148 */
4149static void
4151{
4152 char path[MAXPGPATH];
4153 struct stat stat_buf;
4154
4155 /* Check for pg_wal; if it doesn't exist, error out */
4156 if (stat(XLOGDIR, &stat_buf) != 0 ||
4157 !S_ISDIR(stat_buf.st_mode))
4158 ereport(FATAL,
4160 errmsg("required WAL directory \"%s\" does not exist",
4161 XLOGDIR)));
4162
4163 /* Check for archive_status */
4164 snprintf(path, MAXPGPATH, XLOGDIR "/archive_status");
4165 if (stat(path, &stat_buf) == 0)
4166 {
4167 /* Check for weird cases where it exists but isn't a directory */
4168 if (!S_ISDIR(stat_buf.st_mode))
4169 ereport(FATAL,
4171 errmsg("required WAL directory \"%s\" does not exist",
4172 path)));
4173 }
4174 else
4175 {
4176 ereport(LOG,
4177 (errmsg("creating missing WAL directory \"%s\"", path)));
4178 if (MakePGDirectory(path) < 0)
4179 ereport(FATAL,
4181 errmsg("could not create missing directory \"%s\": %m",
4182 path)));
4183 }
4184
4185 /* Check for summaries */
4186 snprintf(path, MAXPGPATH, XLOGDIR "/summaries");
4187 if (stat(path, &stat_buf) == 0)
4188 {
4189 /* Check for weird cases where it exists but isn't a directory */
4190 if (!S_ISDIR(stat_buf.st_mode))
4191 ereport(FATAL,
4192 (errmsg("required WAL directory \"%s\" does not exist",
4193 path)));
4194 }
4195 else
4196 {
4197 ereport(LOG,
4198 (errmsg("creating missing WAL directory \"%s\"", path)));
4199 if (MakePGDirectory(path) < 0)
4200 ereport(FATAL,
4201 (errmsg("could not create missing directory \"%s\": %m",
4202 path)));
4203 }
4204}
4205
4206/*
4207 * Remove previous backup history files. This also retries creation of
4208 * .ready files for any backup history files for which XLogArchiveNotify
4209 * failed earlier.
4210 */
4211static void
4213{
4214 DIR *xldir;
4215 struct dirent *xlde;
4216 char path[MAXPGPATH + sizeof(XLOGDIR)];
4217
4219
4220 while ((xlde = ReadDir(xldir, XLOGDIR)) != NULL)
4221 {
4222 if (IsBackupHistoryFileName(xlde->d_name))
4223 {
4224 if (XLogArchiveCheckDone(xlde->d_name))
4225 {
4226 elog(DEBUG2, "removing WAL backup history file \"%s\"",
4227 xlde->d_name);
4228 snprintf(path, sizeof(path), XLOGDIR "/%s", xlde->d_name);
4229 unlink(path);
4230 XLogArchiveCleanup(xlde->d_name);
4231 }
4232 }
4233 }
4234
4235 FreeDir(xldir);
4236}
4237
4238/*
4239 * I/O routines for pg_control
4240 *
4241 * *ControlFile is a buffer in shared memory that holds an image of the
4242 * contents of pg_control. WriteControlFile() initializes pg_control
4243 * given a preloaded buffer, ReadControlFile() loads the buffer from
4244 * the pg_control file (during postmaster or standalone-backend startup),
4245 * and UpdateControlFile() rewrites pg_control after we modify xlog state.
4246 * InitControlFile() fills the buffer with initial values.
4247 *
4248 * For simplicity, WriteControlFile() initializes the fields of pg_control
4249 * that are related to checking backend/database compatibility, and
4250 * ReadControlFile() verifies they are correct. We could split out the
4251 * I/O and compatibility-check functions, but there seems no need currently.
4252 */
4253
4254static void
4255InitControlFile(uint64 sysidentifier, uint32 data_checksum_version)
4256{
4258
4259 /*
4260 * Generate a random nonce. This is used for authentication requests that
4261 * will fail because the user does not exist. The nonce is used to create
4262 * a genuine-looking password challenge for the non-existent user, in lieu
4263 * of an actual stored password.
4264 */
4266 ereport(PANIC,
4268 errmsg("could not generate secret authorization token")));
4269
4270 memset(ControlFile, 0, sizeof(ControlFileData));
4271 /* Initialize pg_control status fields */
4272 ControlFile->system_identifier = sysidentifier;
4276
4277 /* Set important parameter values for use when replaying WAL */
4286 ControlFile->data_checksum_version = data_checksum_version;
4287
4288 /*
4289 * Set the data_checksum_version value into XLogCtl, which is where all
4290 * processes get the current value from.
4291 */
4292 XLogCtl->data_checksum_version = data_checksum_version;
4293}
4294
4295static void
4297{
4298 int fd;
4299 char buffer[PG_CONTROL_FILE_SIZE]; /* need not be aligned */
4300
4301 /*
4302 * Initialize version and compatibility-check fields
4303 */
4306
4309
4315
4318
4321
4322 ControlFile->float8ByVal = true; /* vestigial */
4323
4324 /*
4325 * Initialize the default 'char' signedness.
4326 *
4327 * The signedness of the char type is implementation-defined. For instance
4328 * on x86 architecture CPUs, the char data type is typically treated as
4329 * signed by default, whereas on aarch architecture CPUs, it is typically
4330 * treated as unsigned by default. In v17 or earlier, we accidentally let
4331 * C implementation signedness affect persistent data. This led to
4332 * inconsistent results when comparing char data across different
4333 * platforms.
4334 *
4335 * This flag can be used as a hint to ensure consistent behavior for
4336 * pre-v18 data files that store data sorted by the 'char' type on disk,
4337 * especially in cross-platform replication scenarios.
4338 *
4339 * Newly created database clusters unconditionally set the default char
4340 * signedness to true. pg_upgrade changes this flag for clusters that were
4341 * initialized on signedness=false platforms. As a result,
4342 * signedness=false setting will become rare over time. If we had known
4343 * about this problem during the last development cycle that forced initdb
4344 * (v8.3), we would have made all clusters signed or all clusters
4345 * unsigned. Making pg_upgrade the only source of signedness=false will
4346 * cause the population of database clusters to converge toward that
4347 * retrospective ideal.
4348 */
4350
4351 /* Contents are protected with a CRC */
4357
4358 /*
4359 * We write out PG_CONTROL_FILE_SIZE bytes into pg_control, zero-padding
4360 * the excess over sizeof(ControlFileData). This reduces the odds of
4361 * premature-EOF errors when reading pg_control. We'll still fail when we
4362 * check the contents of the file, but hopefully with a more specific
4363 * error than "couldn't read pg_control".
4364 */
4365 memset(buffer, 0, PG_CONTROL_FILE_SIZE);
4366 memcpy(buffer, ControlFile, sizeof(ControlFileData));
4367
4370 if (fd < 0)
4371 ereport(PANIC,
4373 errmsg("could not create file \"%s\": %m",
4375
4376 errno = 0;
4379 {
4380 /* if write didn't set errno, assume problem is no disk space */
4381 if (errno == 0)
4382 errno = ENOSPC;
4383 ereport(PANIC,
4385 errmsg("could not write to file \"%s\": %m",
4387 }
4389
4391 if (pg_fsync(fd) != 0)
4392 ereport(PANIC,
4394 errmsg("could not fsync file \"%s\": %m",
4397
4398 if (close(fd) != 0)
4399 ereport(PANIC,
4401 errmsg("could not close file \"%s\": %m",
4403}
4404
4405static void
4407{
4408 pg_crc32c crc;
4409 int fd;
4410 char wal_segsz_str[20];
4411 int r;
4412
4413 /*
4414 * Read data...
4415 */
4417 O_RDWR | PG_BINARY);
4418 if (fd < 0)
4419 ereport(PANIC,
4421 errmsg("could not open file \"%s\": %m",
4423
4425 r = read(fd, ControlFile, sizeof(ControlFileData));
4426 if (r != sizeof(ControlFileData))
4427 {
4428 if (r < 0)
4429 ereport(PANIC,
4431 errmsg("could not read file \"%s\": %m",
4433 else
4434 ereport(PANIC,
4436 errmsg("could not read file \"%s\": read %d of %zu",
4437 XLOG_CONTROL_FILE, r, sizeof(ControlFileData))));
4438 }
4440
4441 close(fd);
4442
4443 /*
4444 * Check for expected pg_control format version. If this is wrong, the
4445 * CRC check will likely fail because we'll be checking the wrong number
4446 * of bytes. Complaining about wrong version will probably be more
4447 * enlightening than complaining about wrong CRC.
4448 */
4449
4451 ereport(FATAL,
4453 errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
4454 errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with PG_CONTROL_VERSION %d (0x%08x),"
4455 " but the server was compiled with PG_CONTROL_VERSION %d (0x%08x).",
4458 errhint("This could be a problem of mismatched byte ordering. It looks like you need to initdb.")));
4459
4461 ereport(FATAL,
4463 errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
4464 errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with PG_CONTROL_VERSION %d,"
4465 " but the server was compiled with PG_CONTROL_VERSION %d.",
4467 errhint("It looks like you need to initdb.")));
4468
4469 /* Now check the CRC. */
4474 FIN_CRC32C(crc);
4475
4476 if (!EQ_CRC32C(crc, ControlFile->crc))
4477 ereport(FATAL,
4479 errmsg("incorrect checksum in control file")));
4480
4481 /*
4482 * Do compatibility checking immediately. If the database isn't
4483 * compatible with the backend executable, we want to abort before we can
4484 * possibly do any damage.
4485 */
4487 ereport(FATAL,
4489 errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
4490 /* translator: %s is a variable name and %d is its value */
4491 errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with %s %d,"
4492 " but the server was compiled with %s %d.",
4493 "CATALOG_VERSION_NO", ControlFile->catalog_version_no,
4494 "CATALOG_VERSION_NO", CATALOG_VERSION_NO),
4495 errhint("It looks like you need to initdb.")));
4497 ereport(FATAL,
4499 errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
4500 /* translator: %s is a variable name and %d is its value */
4501 errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with %s %d,"
4502 " but the server was compiled with %s %d.",
4503 "MAXALIGN", ControlFile->maxAlign,
4504 "MAXALIGN", MAXIMUM_ALIGNOF),
4505 errhint("It looks like you need to initdb.")));
4507 ereport(FATAL,
4509 errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
4510 errdetail("The database cluster appears to use a different floating-point number format than the server executable."),
4511 errhint("It looks like you need to initdb.")));
4512 if (ControlFile->blcksz != BLCKSZ)
4513 ereport(FATAL,
4515 errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
4516 /* translator: %s is a variable name and %d is its value */
4517 errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with %s %d,"
4518 " but the server was compiled with %s %d.",
4519 "BLCKSZ", ControlFile->blcksz,
4520 "BLCKSZ", BLCKSZ),
4521 errhint("It looks like you need to recompile or initdb.")));
4523 ereport(FATAL,
4525 errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
4526 /* translator: %s is a variable name and %d is its value */
4527 errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with %s %d,"
4528 " but the server was compiled with %s %d.",
4529 "RELSEG_SIZE", ControlFile->relseg_size,
4530 "RELSEG_SIZE", RELSEG_SIZE),
4531 errhint("It looks like you need to recompile or initdb.")));
4533 ereport(FATAL,
4535 errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
4536 /* translator: %s is a variable name and %d is its value */
4537 errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with %s %d,"
4538 " but the server was compiled with %s %d.",
4539 "SLRU_PAGES_PER_SEGMENT", ControlFile->slru_pages_per_segment,
4540 "SLRU_PAGES_PER_SEGMENT", SLRU_PAGES_PER_SEGMENT),
4541 errhint("It looks like you need to recompile or initdb.")));
4543 ereport(FATAL,
4545 errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
4546 /* translator: %s is a variable name and %d is its value */
4547 errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with %s %d,"
4548 " but the server was compiled with %s %d.",
4549 "XLOG_BLCKSZ", ControlFile->xlog_blcksz,
4550 "XLOG_BLCKSZ", XLOG_BLCKSZ),
4551 errhint("It looks like you need to recompile or initdb.")));
4553 ereport(FATAL,
4555 errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
4556 /* translator: %s is a variable name and %d is its value */
4557 errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with %s %d,"
4558 " but the server was compiled with %s %d.",
4559 "NAMEDATALEN", ControlFile->nameDataLen,
4560 "NAMEDATALEN", NAMEDATALEN),
4561 errhint("It looks like you need to recompile or initdb.")));
4563 ereport(FATAL,
4565 errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
4566 /* translator: %s is a variable name and %d is its value */
4567 errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with %s %d,"
4568 " but the server was compiled with %s %d.",
4569 "INDEX_MAX_KEYS", ControlFile->indexMaxKeys,
4570 "INDEX_MAX_KEYS", INDEX_MAX_KEYS),
4571 errhint("It looks like you need to recompile or initdb.")));
4573 ereport(FATAL,
4575 errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
4576 /* translator: %s is a variable name and %d is its value */
4577 errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with %s %d,"
4578 " but the server was compiled with %s %d.",
4579 "TOAST_MAX_CHUNK_SIZE", ControlFile->toast_max_chunk_size,
4580 "TOAST_MAX_CHUNK_SIZE", (int) TOAST_MAX_CHUNK_SIZE),
4581 errhint("It looks like you need to recompile or initdb.")));
4583 ereport(FATAL,
4585 errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
4586 /* translator: %s is a variable name and %d is its value */
4587 errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with %s %d,"
4588 " but the server was compiled with %s %d.",
4589 "LOBLKSIZE", ControlFile->loblksize,
4590 "LOBLKSIZE", (int) LOBLKSIZE),
4591 errhint("It looks like you need to recompile or initdb.")));
4592
4593 Assert(ControlFile->float8ByVal); /* vestigial, not worth an error msg */
4594
4596
4599 errmsg_plural("invalid WAL segment size in control file (%d byte)",
4600 "invalid WAL segment size in control file (%d bytes)",
4603 errdetail("The WAL segment size must be a power of two between 1 MB and 1 GB.")));
4604
4606 SetConfigOption("wal_segment_size", wal_segsz_str, PGC_INTERNAL,
4608
4609 /* check and update variables dependent on wal_segment_size */
4612 /* translator: both %s are GUC names */
4613 errmsg("\"%s\" must be at least twice \"%s\"",
4614 "min_wal_size", "wal_segment_size")));
4615
4618 /* translator: both %s are GUC names */
4619 errmsg("\"%s\" must be at least twice \"%s\"",
4620 "max_wal_size", "wal_segment_size")));
4621
4625
4627}
4628
4629/*
4630 * Utility wrapper to update the control file. Note that the control
4631 * file gets flushed.
4632 */
4633static void
4638
4639/*
4640 * Returns the unique system identifier from control file.
4641 */
4642uint64
4648
4649/*
4650 * Returns the random nonce from control file.
4651 */
4652char *
4658
4659/*
4660 * DataChecksumsNeedWrite
4661 * Returns whether data checksums must be written or not
4662 *
4663 * Returns true if data checksums are enabled, or are in the process of being
4664 * enabled. During "inprogress-on" and "inprogress-off" states checksums must
4665 * be written even though they are not verified (see datachecksum_state.c for
4666 * a longer discussion).
4667 *
4668 * This function is intended for callsites which are about to write a data page
4669 * to storage, and need to know whether to re-calculate the checksum for the
4670 * page header. Calling this function must be performed as close to the write
4671 * operation as possible to keep the critical section short.
4672 */
4673bool
4680
4681
4682bool
4684{
4685 bool ret;
4686
4690
4691 return ret;
4692}
4693
4694bool
4696{
4697 bool ret;
4698
4702
4703 return ret;
4704}
4705
4706bool
4708{
4709 bool ret;
4710
4714
4715 return ret;
4716}
4717
4718/*
4719 * DataChecksumsNeedVerify
4720 * Returns whether data checksums must be verified or not
4721 *
4722 * Data checksums are only verified if they are fully enabled in the cluster.
4723 * During the "inprogress-on" and "inprogress-off" states they are only
4724 * updated, not verified (see datachecksum_state.c for a longer discussion).
4725 *
4726 * This function is intended for callsites which have read data and are about
4727 * to perform checksum validation based on the result of this. Calling this
4728 * function must be performed as close to the validation call as possible to
4729 * keep the critical section short. This is in order to protect against time of
4730 * check/time of use situations around data checksum validation.
4731 */
4732bool
4737
4738/*
4739 * SetDataChecksumsOnInProgress
4740 * Sets the data checksum state to "inprogress-on" to enable checksums
4741 *
4742 * To start the process of enabling data checksums in a running cluster the
4743 * data_checksum_version state must be changed to "inprogress-on". See
4744 * SetDataChecksumsOn below for a description on how this state change works.
4745 * This function blocks until all backends in the cluster have acknowledged the
4746 * state transition.
4747 */
4748void
4778
4779/*
4780 * SetDataChecksumsOn
4781 * Set data checksums state to 'on' cluster-wide
4782 *
4783 * Enabling data checksums is performed using two barriers, the first one to
4784 * set the state to "inprogress-on" (done by SetDataChecksumsOnInProgress())
4785 * and the second one to set the state to "on" (done here). Below is a short
4786 * description of the processing, a more detailed write-up can be found in
4787 * datachecksum_state.c.
4788 *
4789 * To start the process of enabling data checksums in a running cluster the
4790 * data_checksum_version state must be changed to "inprogress-on". This state
4791 * requires data checksums to be written but not verified. This ensures that
4792 * all data pages can be checksummed without the risk of false negatives in
4793 * validation during the process. When all existing pages are guaranteed to
4794 * have checksums, and all new pages will be initiated with checksums, the
4795 * state can be changed to "on". Once the state is "on" checksums will be both
4796 * written and verified.
4797 *
4798 * This function blocks until all backends in the cluster have acknowledged the
4799 * state transition.
4800 */
4801void
4803{
4805
4807
4808 /*
4809 * The only allowed state transition to "on" is from "inprogress-on" since
4810 * that state ensures that all pages will have data checksums written. No
4811 * such state transition exists, if it does happen it's likely due to a
4812 * programmer error.
4813 */
4815 {
4817 elog(WARNING,
4818 "cannot set data checksums to \"on\", current state is not \"inprogress-on\", disabling");
4820 return;
4821 }
4822
4824
4825 INJECTION_POINT("datachecksums-enable-checksums-delay", NULL);
4828
4830
4834
4835 /*
4836 * Update the controlfile before waiting since if we have an immediate
4837 * shutdown while waiting we want to come back up with checksums enabled.
4838 */
4843
4845
4848
4851}
4852
4853/*
4854 * SetDataChecksumsOff
4855 * Disables data checksums cluster-wide
4856 *
4857 * Disabling data checksums must be performed with two sets of barriers, each
4858 * carrying a different state. The state is first set to "inprogress-off"
4859 * during which checksums are still written but not verified. This ensures that
4860 * backends which have yet to observe the state change from "on" won't get
4861 * validation errors on concurrently modified pages. Once all backends have
4862 * changed to "inprogress-off", the barrier for moving to "off" can be emitted.
4863 * This function blocks until all backends in the cluster have acknowledged the
4864 * state transition.
4865 */
4866void
4868{
4870
4872
4873 /* If data checksums are already disabled there is nothing to do */
4875 {
4877 return;
4878 }
4879
4880 /*
4881 * If data checksums are currently enabled, or in the process of being
4882 * enabled, we first transition to the "inprogress-off" state during which
4883 * backends continue to write checksums without verifying them. When all
4884 * backends are in "inprogress-off" the next transition to "off" can be
4885 * performed, after which all data checksum processing is disabled.
4886 */
4889 {
4891
4894
4896
4900
4905
4907
4910
4913
4914 /*
4915 * At this point we know that no backends are verifying data checksums
4916 * during reading. Next, we can safely move to state "off" to also
4917 * stop writing checksums.
4918 */
4919 }
4920 else
4921 {
4922 /*
4923 * Ending up here implies that the checksums state is "inprogress-off"
4924 * and we can transition directly to "off" from there.
4925 */
4927 }
4928
4930 /* Ensure that we don't incur a checkpoint during disabling checksums */
4932
4934
4938
4943
4945
4948
4951}
4952
4953/*
4954 * InitLocalDataChecksumState
4955 *
4956 * Set up backend local caches of controldata variables which may change at
4957 * any point during runtime and thus require special cased locking. So far
4958 * this only applies to data_checksum_version, but it's intended to be general
4959 * purpose enough to handle future cases.
4960 */
4961void
4969
4970void
4971SetLocalDataChecksumState(uint32 data_checksum_version)
4972{
4973 LocalDataChecksumState = data_checksum_version;
4974
4975 data_checksums = data_checksum_version;
4976}
4977
4978/* guc hook */
4979const char *
4984
4985/*
4986 * Return true if the cluster was initialized on a platform where the
4987 * default signedness of char is "signed". This function exists for code
4988 * that deals with pre-v18 data files that store data sorted by the 'char'
4989 * type on disk (e.g., GIN and GiST indexes). See the comments in
4990 * WriteControlFile() for details.
4991 */
4992bool
4997
4998/*
4999 * Returns a fake LSN for unlogged relations.
5000 *
5001 * Each call generates an LSN that is greater than any previous value
5002 * returned. The current counter value is saved and restored across clean
5003 * shutdowns, but like unlogged relations, does not survive a crash. This can
5004 * be used in lieu of real LSN values returned by XLogInsert, if you need an
5005 * LSN-like increasing sequence of numbers without writing any WAL.
5006 */
5012
5013/*
5014 * Auto-tune the number of XLOG buffers.
5015 *
5016 * The preferred setting for wal_buffers is about 3% of shared_buffers, with
5017 * a maximum of one XLOG segment (there is little reason to think that more
5018 * is helpful, at least so long as we force an fsync when switching log files)
5019 * and a minimum of 8 blocks (which was the default value prior to PostgreSQL
5020 * 9.1, when auto-tuning was added).
5021 *
5022 * This should not be called until NBuffers has received its final value.
5023 */
5024static int
5026{
5027 int xbuffers;
5028
5029 xbuffers = NBuffers / 32;
5032 if (xbuffers < 8)
5033 xbuffers = 8;
5034 return xbuffers;
5035}
5036
5037/*
5038 * GUC check_hook for wal_buffers
5039 */
5040bool
5042{
5043 /*
5044 * -1 indicates a request for auto-tune.
5045 */
5046 if (*newval == -1)
5047 {
5048 /*
5049 * If we haven't yet changed the boot_val default of -1, just let it
5050 * be. We'll fix it when XLOGShmemRequest is called.
5051 */
5052 if (XLOGbuffers == -1)
5053 return true;
5054
5055 /* Otherwise, substitute the auto-tune value */
5057 }
5058
5059 /*
5060 * We clamp manually-set values to at least 4 blocks. Prior to PostgreSQL
5061 * 9.1, a minimum of 4 was enforced by guc.c, but since that is no longer
5062 * the case, we just silently treat such values as a request for the
5063 * minimum. (We could throw an error instead, but that doesn't seem very
5064 * helpful.)
5065 */
5066 if (*newval < 4)
5067 *newval = 4;
5068
5069 return true;
5070}
5071
5072/*
5073 * GUC check_hook for wal_consistency_checking
5074 */
5075bool
5077{
5078 char *rawstring;
5079 List *elemlist;
5080 ListCell *l;
5081 bool newwalconsistency[RM_MAX_ID + 1];
5082
5083 /* Initialize the array */
5084 MemSet(newwalconsistency, 0, (RM_MAX_ID + 1) * sizeof(bool));
5085
5086 /* Need a modifiable copy of string */
5088
5089 /* Parse string into list of identifiers */
5091 {
5092 /* syntax error in list */
5093 GUC_check_errdetail("List syntax is invalid.");
5096 return false;
5097 }
5098
5099 foreach(l, elemlist)
5100 {
5101 char *tok = (char *) lfirst(l);
5102 int rmid;
5103
5104 /* Check for 'all'. */
5105 if (pg_strcasecmp(tok, "all") == 0)
5106 {
5107 for (rmid = 0; rmid <= RM_MAX_ID; rmid++)
5108 if (RmgrIdExists(rmid) && GetRmgr(rmid).rm_mask != NULL)
5109 newwalconsistency[rmid] = true;
5110 }
5111 else
5112 {
5113 /* Check if the token matches any known resource manager. */
5114 bool found = false;
5115
5116 for (rmid = 0; rmid <= RM_MAX_ID; rmid++)
5117 {
5118 if (RmgrIdExists(rmid) && GetRmgr(rmid).rm_mask != NULL &&
5119 pg_strcasecmp(tok, GetRmgr(rmid).rm_name) == 0)
5120 {
5121 newwalconsistency[rmid] = true;
5122 found = true;
5123 break;
5124 }
5125 }
5126 if (!found)
5127 {
5128 /*
5129 * During startup, it might be a not-yet-loaded custom
5130 * resource manager. Defer checking until
5131 * InitializeWalConsistencyChecking().
5132 */
5134 {
5136 }
5137 else
5138 {
5139 GUC_check_errdetail("Unrecognized key word: \"%s\".", tok);
5142 return false;
5143 }
5144 }
5145 }
5146 }
5147
5150
5151 /* assign new value */
5152 *extra = guc_malloc(LOG, (RM_MAX_ID + 1) * sizeof(bool));
5153 if (!*extra)
5154 return false;
5155 memcpy(*extra, newwalconsistency, (RM_MAX_ID + 1) * sizeof(bool));
5156 return true;
5157}
5158
5159/*
5160 * GUC assign_hook for wal_consistency_checking
5161 */
5162void
5164{
5165 /*
5166 * If some checks were deferred, it's possible that the checks will fail
5167 * later during InitializeWalConsistencyChecking(). But in that case, the
5168 * postmaster will exit anyway, so it's safe to proceed with the
5169 * assignment.
5170 *
5171 * Any built-in resource managers specified are assigned immediately,
5172 * which affects WAL created before shared_preload_libraries are
5173 * processed. Any custom resource managers specified won't be assigned
5174 * until after shared_preload_libraries are processed, but that's OK
5175 * because WAL for a custom resource manager can't be written before the
5176 * module is loaded anyway.
5177 */
5179}
5180
5181/*
5182 * InitializeWalConsistencyChecking: run after loading custom resource managers
5183 *
5184 * If any unknown resource managers were specified in the
5185 * wal_consistency_checking GUC, processing was deferred. Now that
5186 * shared_preload_libraries have been loaded, process wal_consistency_checking
5187 * again.
5188 */
5189void
5191{
5193
5195 {
5196 struct config_generic *guc;
5197
5198 guc = find_option("wal_consistency_checking", false, false, ERROR);
5199
5201
5202 set_config_option_ext("wal_consistency_checking",
5204 guc->scontext, guc->source, guc->srole,
5205 GUC_ACTION_SET, true, ERROR, false);
5206
5207 /* checking should not be deferred again */
5209 }
5210}
5211
5212/*
5213 * GUC show_hook for archive_command
5214 */
5215const char *
5217{
5218 if (XLogArchivingActive())
5219 return XLogArchiveCommand;
5220 else
5221 return "(disabled)";
5222}
5223
5224/*
5225 * GUC show_hook for in_hot_standby
5226 */
5227const char *
5229{
5230 /*
5231 * We display the actual state based on shared memory, so that this GUC
5232 * reports up-to-date state if examined intra-query. The underlying
5233 * variable (in_hot_standby_guc) changes only when we transmit a new value
5234 * to the client.
5235 */
5236 return RecoveryInProgress() ? "on" : "off";
5237}
5238
5239/*
5240 * GUC show_hook for effective_wal_level
5241 */
5242const char *
5244{
5246 return "minimal";
5247
5248 /*
5249 * During recovery, effective_wal_level reflects the primary's
5250 * configuration rather than the local wal_level value.
5251 */
5252 if (RecoveryInProgress())
5253 return IsXLogLogicalInfoEnabled() ? "logical" : "replica";
5254
5255 return XLogLogicalInfoActive() ? "logical" : "replica";
5256}
5257
5258/*
5259 * Read the control file, set respective GUCs.
5260 *
5261 * This is to be called during startup, including a crash recovery cycle,
5262 * unless in bootstrap mode, where no control file yet exists. As there's no
5263 * usable shared memory yet (its sizing can depend on the contents of the
5264 * control file!), first store the contents in local memory. XLOGShmemInit()
5265 * will then copy it to shared memory later.
5266 *
5267 * reset just controls whether previous contents are to be expected (in the
5268 * reset case, there's a dangling pointer into old shared memory), or not.
5269 */
5270void
5279
5280/*
5281 * Get the wal_level from the control file. For a standby, this value should be
5282 * considered as its active wal_level, because it may be different from what
5283 * was originally configured on standby.
5284 */
5287{
5288 return ControlFile->wal_level;
5289}
5290
5291/*
5292 * Register shared memory for XLOG.
5293 */
5294static void
5296{
5297 Size size;
5298
5299 /*
5300 * If the value of wal_buffers is -1, use the preferred auto-tune value.
5301 * This isn't an amazingly clean place to do this, but we must wait till
5302 * NBuffers has received its final value, and must do it before using the
5303 * value of XLOGbuffers to do anything important.
5304 *
5305 * We prefer to report this value's source as PGC_S_DYNAMIC_DEFAULT.
5306 * However, if the DBA explicitly set wal_buffers = -1 in the config file,
5307 * then PGC_S_DYNAMIC_DEFAULT will fail to override that and we must force
5308 * the matter with PGC_S_OVERRIDE.
5309 */
5310 if (XLOGbuffers == -1)
5311 {
5312 char buf[32];
5313
5314 snprintf(buf, sizeof(buf), "%d", XLOGChooseNumBuffers());
5315 SetConfigOption("wal_buffers", buf, PGC_POSTMASTER,
5317 if (XLOGbuffers == -1) /* failed to apply it? */
5318 SetConfigOption("wal_buffers", buf, PGC_POSTMASTER,
5320 }
5321 Assert(XLOGbuffers > 0);
5322
5323 /* XLogCtl */
5324 size = sizeof(XLogCtlData);
5325
5326 /* WAL insertion locks, plus alignment */
5327 size = add_size(size, mul_size(sizeof(WALInsertLockPadded), NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS + 1));
5328 /* xlblocks array */
5329 size = add_size(size, mul_size(sizeof(pg_atomic_uint64), XLOGbuffers));
5330 /* extra alignment padding for XLOG I/O buffers */
5331 size = add_size(size, Max(XLOG_BLCKSZ, PG_IO_ALIGN_SIZE));
5332 /* and the buffers themselves */
5333 size = add_size(size, mul_size(XLOG_BLCKSZ, XLOGbuffers));
5334
5335 ShmemRequestStruct(.name = "XLOG Ctl",
5336 .size = size,
5337 .ptr = (void **) &XLogCtl,
5338 );
5339 ShmemRequestStruct(.name = "Control File",
5340 .size = sizeof(ControlFileData),
5341 .ptr = (void **) &ControlFile,
5342 );
5343}
5344
5345/*
5346 * XLOGShmemInit - initialize the XLogCtl shared memory area.
5347 */
5348static void
5350{
5351 char *allocptr;
5352 int i;
5353
5354#ifdef WAL_DEBUG
5355
5356 /*
5357 * Create a memory context for WAL debugging that's exempt from the normal
5358 * "no pallocs in critical section" rule. Yes, that can lead to a PANIC if
5359 * an allocation fails, but wal_debug is not for production use anyway.
5360 */
5361 if (walDebugCxt == NULL)
5362 {
5364 "WAL Debug",
5367 }
5368#endif
5369
5370 memset(XLogCtl, 0, sizeof(XLogCtlData));
5371
5372 /*
5373 * Already have read control file locally, unless in bootstrap mode. Move
5374 * contents into shared memory.
5375 */
5376 if (LocalControlFile)
5377 {
5381 }
5382
5383 /*
5384 * Since XLogCtlData contains XLogRecPtr fields, its sizeof should be a
5385 * multiple of the alignment for same, so no extra alignment padding is
5386 * needed here.
5387 */
5388 allocptr = ((char *) XLogCtl) + sizeof(XLogCtlData);
5391
5392 for (i = 0; i < XLOGbuffers; i++)
5393 {
5395 }
5396
5397 /* WAL insertion locks. Ensure they're aligned to the full padded size */
5398 allocptr += sizeof(WALInsertLockPadded) -
5403
5404 for (i = 0; i < NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS; i++)
5405 {
5409 }
5410
5411 /*
5412 * Align the start of the page buffers to a full xlog block size boundary.
5413 * This simplifies some calculations in XLOG insertion. It is also
5414 * required for O_DIRECT.
5415 */
5419
5420 /*
5421 * Do basic initialization of XLogCtl shared data. (StartupXLOG will fill
5422 * in additional info.)
5423 */
5427 XLogCtl->WalWriterSleeping = false;
5428
5429 /* Use the checksum info from control file */
5432
5439}
5440
5441/*
5442 * XLOGShmemAttach - re-establish WALInsertLocks pointer after attaching.
5443 */
5444static void
5449
5450/*
5451 * This func must be called ONCE on system install. It creates pg_control
5452 * and the initial XLOG segment.
5453 */
5454void
5455BootStrapXLOG(uint32 data_checksum_version)
5456{
5457 CheckPoint checkPoint;
5458 PGAlignedXLogBlock buffer;
5459 XLogPageHeader page;
5461 XLogRecord *record;
5462 char *recptr;
5463 uint64 sysidentifier;
5464 struct timeval tv;
5465 pg_crc32c crc;
5466
5467 /* allow ordinary WAL segment creation, like StartupXLOG() would */
5469
5470 /*
5471 * Select a hopefully-unique system identifier code for this installation.
5472 * We use the result of gettimeofday(), including the fractional seconds
5473 * field, as being about as unique as we can easily get. (Think not to
5474 * use random(), since it hasn't been seeded and there's no portable way
5475 * to seed it other than the system clock value...) The upper half of the
5476 * uint64 value is just the tv_sec part, while the lower half contains the
5477 * tv_usec part (which must fit in 20 bits), plus 12 bits from our current
5478 * PID for a little extra uniqueness. A person knowing this encoding can
5479 * determine the initialization time of the installation, which could
5480 * perhaps be useful sometimes.
5481 */
5482 gettimeofday(&tv, NULL);
5483 sysidentifier = ((uint64) tv.tv_sec) << 32;
5484 sysidentifier |= ((uint64) tv.tv_usec) << 12;
5485 sysidentifier |= getpid() & 0xFFF;
5486
5487 memset(&buffer, 0, sizeof buffer);
5488 page = (XLogPageHeader) &buffer;
5489
5490 /*
5491 * Set up information for the initial checkpoint record
5492 *
5493 * The initial checkpoint record is written to the beginning of the WAL
5494 * segment with logid=0 logseg=1. The very first WAL segment, 0/0, is not
5495 * used, so that we can use 0/0 to mean "before any valid WAL segment".
5496 */
5500 checkPoint.fullPageWrites = fullPageWrites;
5502 checkPoint.wal_level = wal_level;
5503 checkPoint.nextXid =
5505 checkPoint.nextOid = FirstGenbkiObjectId;
5506 checkPoint.nextMulti = FirstMultiXactId;
5507 checkPoint.nextMultiOffset = 1;
5509 checkPoint.oldestXidDB = Template1DbOid;
5510 checkPoint.oldestMulti = FirstMultiXactId;
5511 checkPoint.oldestMultiDB = Template1DbOid;
5514 checkPoint.time = (pg_time_t) time(NULL);
5516 checkPoint.dataChecksumState = data_checksum_version;
5517
5518 TransamVariables->nextXid = checkPoint.nextXid;
5519 TransamVariables->nextOid = checkPoint.nextOid;
5521 MultiXactSetNextMXact(checkPoint.nextMulti, checkPoint.nextMultiOffset);
5522 AdvanceOldestClogXid(checkPoint.oldestXid);
5523 SetTransactionIdLimit(checkPoint.oldestXid, checkPoint.oldestXidDB);
5524 SetMultiXactIdLimit(checkPoint.oldestMulti, checkPoint.oldestMultiDB);
5526
5527 /* Set up the XLOG page header */
5528 page->xlp_magic = XLOG_PAGE_MAGIC;
5529 page->xlp_info = XLP_LONG_HEADER;
5533 longpage->xlp_sysid = sysidentifier;
5534 longpage->xlp_seg_size = wal_segment_size;
5535 longpage->xlp_xlog_blcksz = XLOG_BLCKSZ;
5536
5537 /* Insert the initial checkpoint record */
5538 recptr = ((char *) page + SizeOfXLogLongPHD);
5539 record = (XLogRecord *) recptr;
5540 record->xl_prev = InvalidXLogRecPtr;
5541 record->xl_xid = InvalidTransactionId;
5542 record->xl_tot_len = SizeOfXLogRecord + SizeOfXLogRecordDataHeaderShort + sizeof(checkPoint);
5544 record->xl_rmid = RM_XLOG_ID;
5546 /* fill the XLogRecordDataHeaderShort struct */
5547 *(recptr++) = (char) XLR_BLOCK_ID_DATA_SHORT;
5548 *(recptr++) = sizeof(checkPoint);
5549 memcpy(recptr, &checkPoint, sizeof(checkPoint));
5550 recptr += sizeof(checkPoint);
5551 Assert(recptr - (char *) record == record->xl_tot_len);
5552
5554 COMP_CRC32C(crc, ((char *) record) + SizeOfXLogRecord, record->xl_tot_len - SizeOfXLogRecord);
5555 COMP_CRC32C(crc, (char *) record, offsetof(XLogRecord, xl_crc));
5556 FIN_CRC32C(crc);
5557 record->xl_crc = crc;
5558
5559 /* Create first XLOG segment file */
5562
5563 /*
5564 * We needn't bother with Reserve/ReleaseExternalFD here, since we'll
5565 * close the file again in a moment.
5566 */
5567
5568 /* Write the first page with the initial record */
5569 errno = 0;
5571 if (write(openLogFile, &buffer, XLOG_BLCKSZ) != XLOG_BLCKSZ)
5572 {
5573 /* if write didn't set errno, assume problem is no disk space */
5574 if (errno == 0)
5575 errno = ENOSPC;
5576 ereport(PANIC,
5578 errmsg("could not write bootstrap write-ahead log file: %m")));
5579 }
5581
5583 if (pg_fsync(openLogFile) != 0)
5584 ereport(PANIC,
5586 errmsg("could not fsync bootstrap write-ahead log file: %m")));
5588
5589 if (close(openLogFile) != 0)
5590 ereport(PANIC,
5592 errmsg("could not close bootstrap write-ahead log file: %m")));
5593
5594 openLogFile = -1;
5595
5596 /* Now create pg_control */
5597 InitControlFile(sysidentifier, data_checksum_version);
5598 ControlFile->time = checkPoint.time;
5599 ControlFile->checkPoint = checkPoint.redo;
5600 ControlFile->checkPointCopy = checkPoint;
5601
5602 /* some additional ControlFile fields are set in WriteControlFile() */
5604
5605 /* Bootstrap the commit log, too */
5606 BootStrapCLOG();
5610
5611 /*
5612 * Force control file to be read - in contrast to normal processing we'd
5613 * otherwise never run the checks and GUC related initializations therein.
5614 */
5616}
5617
5618static char *
5620{
5622 "%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S %Z",
5624
5625 return buf;
5626}
5627
5628/*
5629 * Initialize the first WAL segment on new timeline.
5630 */
5631static void
5633{
5634 char xlogfname[MAXFNAMELEN];
5637
5638 /* we always switch to a new timeline after archive recovery */
5639 Assert(endTLI != newTLI);
5640
5641 /*
5642 * Update min recovery point one last time.
5643 */
5645
5646 /*
5647 * Calculate the last segment on the old timeline, and the first segment
5648 * on the new timeline. If the switch happens in the middle of a segment,
5649 * they are the same, but if the switch happens exactly at a segment
5650 * boundary, startLogSegNo will be endLogSegNo + 1.
5651 */
5654
5655 /*
5656 * Initialize the starting WAL segment for the new timeline. If the switch
5657 * happens in the middle of a segment, copy data from the last WAL segment
5658 * of the old timeline up to the switch point, to the starting WAL segment
5659 * on the new timeline.
5660 */
5662 {
5663 /*
5664 * Make a copy of the file on the new timeline.
5665 *
5666 * Writing WAL isn't allowed yet, so there are no locking
5667 * considerations. But we should be just as tense as XLogFileInit to
5668 * avoid emplacing a bogus file.
5669 */
5672 }
5673 else
5674 {
5675 /*
5676 * The switch happened at a segment boundary, so just create the next
5677 * segment on the new timeline.
5678 */
5679 int fd;
5680
5682
5683 if (close(fd) != 0)
5684 {
5685 int save_errno = errno;
5686
5688 errno = save_errno;
5689 ereport(ERROR,
5691 errmsg("could not close file \"%s\": %m", xlogfname)));
5692 }
5693 }
5694
5695 /*
5696 * Let's just make real sure there are not .ready or .done flags posted
5697 * for the new segment.
5698 */
5701}
5702
5703/*
5704 * Perform cleanup actions at the conclusion of archive recovery.
5705 */
5706static void
5709{
5710 /*
5711 * Execute the recovery_end_command, if any.
5712 */
5715 "recovery_end_command",
5716 true,
5718
5719 /*
5720 * We switched to a new timeline. Clean up segments on the old timeline.
5721 *
5722 * If there are any higher-numbered segments on the old timeline, remove
5723 * them. They might contain valid WAL, but they might also be
5724 * pre-allocated files containing garbage. In any case, they are not part
5725 * of the new timeline's history so we don't need them.
5726 */
5728
5729 /*
5730 * If the switch happened in the middle of a segment, what to do with the
5731 * last, partial segment on the old timeline? If we don't archive it, and
5732 * the server that created the WAL never archives it either (e.g. because
5733 * it was hit by a meteor), it will never make it to the archive. That's
5734 * OK from our point of view, because the new segment that we created with
5735 * the new TLI contains all the WAL from the old timeline up to the switch
5736 * point. But if you later try to do PITR to the "missing" WAL on the old
5737 * timeline, recovery won't find it in the archive. It's physically
5738 * present in the new file with new TLI, but recovery won't look there
5739 * when it's recovering to the older timeline. On the other hand, if we
5740 * archive the partial segment, and the original server on that timeline
5741 * is still running and archives the completed version of the same segment
5742 * later, it will fail. (We used to do that in 9.4 and below, and it
5743 * caused such problems).
5744 *
5745 * As a compromise, we rename the last segment with the .partial suffix,
5746 * and archive it. Archive recovery will never try to read .partial
5747 * segments, so they will normally go unused. But in the odd PITR case,
5748 * the administrator can copy them manually to the pg_wal directory
5749 * (removing the suffix). They can be useful in debugging, too.
5750 *
5751 * If a .done or .ready file already exists for the old timeline, however,
5752 * we had already determined that the segment is complete, so we can let
5753 * it be archived normally. (In particular, if it was restored from the
5754 * archive to begin with, it's expected to have a .done file).
5755 */
5758 {
5759 char origfname[MAXFNAMELEN];
5761
5764
5766 {
5767 char origpath[MAXPGPATH];
5769 char partialpath[MAXPGPATH];
5770
5771 /*
5772 * If we're summarizing WAL, we can't rename the partial file
5773 * until the summarizer finishes with it, else it will fail.
5774 */
5775 if (summarize_wal)
5777
5779 snprintf(partialfname, MAXFNAMELEN, "%s.partial", origfname);
5780 snprintf(partialpath, MAXPGPATH, "%s.partial", origpath);
5781
5782 /*
5783 * Make sure there's no .done or .ready file for the .partial
5784 * file.
5785 */
5787
5790 }
5791 }
5792}
5793
5794/*
5795 * Check to see if required parameters are set high enough on this server
5796 * for various aspects of recovery operation.
5797 *
5798 * Note that all the parameters which this function tests need to be
5799 * listed in Administrator's Overview section in high-availability.sgml.
5800 * If you change them, don't forget to update the list.
5801 */
5802static void
5804{
5805 /*
5806 * For archive recovery, the WAL must be generated with at least 'replica'
5807 * wal_level.
5808 */
5810 {
5811 ereport(FATAL,
5813 errmsg("WAL was generated with \"wal_level=minimal\", cannot continue recovering"),
5814 errdetail("This happens if you temporarily set \"wal_level=minimal\" on the server."),
5815 errhint("Use a backup taken after setting \"wal_level\" to higher than \"minimal\".")));
5816 }
5817
5818 /*
5819 * For Hot Standby, the WAL must be generated with 'replica' mode, and we
5820 * must have at least as many backend slots as the primary.
5821 */
5823 {
5824 /* We ignore autovacuum_worker_slots when we make this test. */
5825 RecoveryRequiresIntParameter("max_connections",
5828 RecoveryRequiresIntParameter("max_worker_processes",
5831 RecoveryRequiresIntParameter("max_wal_senders",
5834 RecoveryRequiresIntParameter("max_prepared_transactions",
5837 RecoveryRequiresIntParameter("max_locks_per_transaction",
5840 }
5841}
5842
5843/*
5844 * This must be called ONCE during postmaster or standalone-backend startup
5845 */
5846void
5848{
5850 CheckPoint checkPoint;
5851 bool wasShutdown;
5852 bool didCrash;
5853 bool haveTblspcMap;
5854 bool haveBackupLabel;
5863 bool promoted = false;
5864 char timebuf[128];
5865
5866 /*
5867 * We should have an aux process resource owner to use, and we should not
5868 * be in a transaction that's installed some other resowner.
5869 */
5874
5875 /*
5876 * Check that contents look valid.
5877 */
5879 ereport(FATAL,
5881 errmsg("control file contains invalid checkpoint location")));
5882
5883 switch (ControlFile->state)
5884 {
5885 case DB_SHUTDOWNED:
5886
5887 /*
5888 * This is the expected case, so don't be chatty in standalone
5889 * mode
5890 */
5892 (errmsg("database system was shut down at %s",
5894 timebuf, sizeof(timebuf)))));
5895 break;
5896
5898 ereport(LOG,
5899 (errmsg("database system was shut down in recovery at %s",
5901 timebuf, sizeof(timebuf)))));
5902 break;
5903
5904 case DB_SHUTDOWNING:
5905 ereport(LOG,
5906 (errmsg("database system shutdown was interrupted; last known up at %s",
5908 timebuf, sizeof(timebuf)))));
5909 break;
5910
5912 ereport(LOG,
5913 (errmsg("database system was interrupted while in recovery at %s",
5915 timebuf, sizeof(timebuf))),
5916 errhint("This probably means that some data is corrupted and"
5917 " you will have to use the last backup for recovery.")));
5918 break;
5919
5921 ereport(LOG,
5922 (errmsg("database system was interrupted while in recovery at log time %s",
5924 timebuf, sizeof(timebuf))),
5925 errhint("If this has occurred more than once some data might be corrupted"
5926 " and you might need to choose an earlier recovery target.")));
5927 break;
5928
5929 case DB_IN_PRODUCTION:
5930 ereport(LOG,
5931 (errmsg("database system was interrupted; last known up at %s",
5933 timebuf, sizeof(timebuf)))));
5934 break;
5935
5936 default:
5937 ereport(FATAL,
5939 errmsg("control file contains invalid database cluster state")));
5940 }
5941
5942 /* This is just to allow attaching to startup process with a debugger */
5943#ifdef XLOG_REPLAY_DELAY
5945 pg_usleep(60000000L);
5946#endif
5947
5948 /*
5949 * Verify that pg_wal, pg_wal/archive_status, and pg_wal/summaries exist.
5950 * In cases where someone has performed a copy for PITR, these directories
5951 * may have been excluded and need to be re-created.
5952 */
5954
5955 /* Set up timeout handler needed to report startup progress. */
5959
5960 /*----------
5961 * If we previously crashed, perform a couple of actions:
5962 *
5963 * - The pg_wal directory may still include some temporary WAL segments
5964 * used when creating a new segment, so perform some clean up to not
5965 * bloat this path. This is done first as there is no point to sync
5966 * this temporary data.
5967 *
5968 * - There might be data which we had written, intending to fsync it, but
5969 * which we had not actually fsync'd yet. Therefore, a power failure in
5970 * the near future might cause earlier unflushed writes to be lost, even
5971 * though more recent data written to disk from here on would be
5972 * persisted. To avoid that, fsync the entire data directory.
5973 */
5976 {
5979 didCrash = true;
5980 }
5981 else
5982 didCrash = false;
5983
5984 /*
5985 * Prepare for WAL recovery if needed.
5986 *
5987 * InitWalRecovery analyzes the control file and the backup label file, if
5988 * any. It updates the in-memory ControlFile buffer according to the
5989 * starting checkpoint, and sets InRecovery and ArchiveRecoveryRequested.
5990 * It also applies the tablespace map file, if any.
5991 */
5994 checkPoint = ControlFile->checkPointCopy;
5995
5996 /* initialize shared memory variables from the checkpoint record */
5997 TransamVariables->nextXid = checkPoint.nextXid;
5998 TransamVariables->nextOid = checkPoint.nextOid;
6000 MultiXactSetNextMXact(checkPoint.nextMulti, checkPoint.nextMultiOffset);
6001 AdvanceOldestClogXid(checkPoint.oldestXid);
6002 SetTransactionIdLimit(checkPoint.oldestXid, checkPoint.oldestXidDB);
6003 SetMultiXactIdLimit(checkPoint.oldestMulti, checkPoint.oldestMultiDB);
6005 checkPoint.newestCommitTsXid);
6006
6007 /*
6008 * Clear out any old relcache cache files. This is *necessary* if we do
6009 * any WAL replay, since that would probably result in the cache files
6010 * being out of sync with database reality. In theory we could leave them
6011 * in place if the database had been cleanly shut down, but it seems
6012 * safest to just remove them always and let them be rebuilt during the
6013 * first backend startup. These files needs to be removed from all
6014 * directories including pg_tblspc, however the symlinks are created only
6015 * after reading tablespace_map file in case of archive recovery from
6016 * backup, so needs to clear old relcache files here after creating
6017 * symlinks.
6018 */
6020
6021 /*
6022 * Initialize replication slots, before there's a chance to remove
6023 * required resources.
6024 */
6026
6027 /*
6028 * Startup the logical decoding status with the last status stored in the
6029 * checkpoint record.
6030 */
6032
6033 /*
6034 * Startup logical state, needs to be setup now so we have proper data
6035 * during crash recovery.
6036 */
6038
6039 /*
6040 * Startup CLOG. This must be done after TransamVariables->nextXid has
6041 * been initialized and before we accept connections or begin WAL replay.
6042 */
6043 StartupCLOG();
6044
6045 /*
6046 * Startup MultiXact. We need to do this early to be able to replay
6047 * truncations.
6048 */
6050
6051 /*
6052 * Ditto for commit timestamps. Activate the facility if the setting is
6053 * enabled in the control file, as there should be no tracking of commit
6054 * timestamps done when the setting was disabled. This facility can be
6055 * started or stopped when replaying a XLOG_PARAMETER_CHANGE record.
6056 */
6059
6060 /*
6061 * Recover knowledge about replay progress of known replication partners.
6062 */
6064
6065 /*
6066 * Initialize unlogged LSN. On a clean shutdown, it's restored from the
6067 * control file. On recovery, all unlogged relations are blown away, so
6068 * the unlogged LSN counter can be reset too.
6069 */
6073 else
6076
6077 /*
6078 * Copy any missing timeline history files between 'now' and the recovery
6079 * target timeline from archive to pg_wal. While we don't need those files
6080 * ourselves - the history file of the recovery target timeline covers all
6081 * the previous timelines in the history too - a cascading standby server
6082 * might be interested in them. Or, if you archive the WAL from this
6083 * server to a different archive than the primary, it'd be good for all
6084 * the history files to get archived there after failover, so that you can
6085 * use one of the old timelines as a PITR target. Timeline history files
6086 * are small, so it's better to copy them unnecessarily than not copy them
6087 * and regret later.
6088 */
6090
6091 /*
6092 * Before running in recovery, scan pg_twophase and fill in its status to
6093 * be able to work on entries generated by redo. Doing a scan before
6094 * taking any recovery action has the merit to discard any 2PC files that
6095 * are newer than the first record to replay, saving from any conflicts at
6096 * replay. This avoids as well any subsequent scans when doing recovery
6097 * of the on-disk two-phase data.
6098 */
6100
6101 /*
6102 * When starting with crash recovery, reset pgstat data - it might not be
6103 * valid. Otherwise restore pgstat data. It's safe to do this here,
6104 * because postmaster will not yet have started any other processes.
6105 *
6106 * NB: Restoring replication slot stats relies on slot state to have
6107 * already been restored from disk.
6108 *
6109 * TODO: With a bit of extra work we could just start with a pgstat file
6110 * associated with the checkpoint redo location we're starting from.
6111 */
6112 if (didCrash)
6114 else
6116
6118
6121
6122 /* REDO */
6123 if (InRecovery)
6124 {
6125 /* Initialize state for RecoveryInProgress() */
6129 else
6132
6133 /*
6134 * Update pg_control to show that we are recovering and to show the
6135 * selected checkpoint as the place we are starting from. We also mark
6136 * pg_control with any minimum recovery stop point obtained from a
6137 * backup history file.
6138 *
6139 * No need to hold ControlFileLock yet, we aren't up far enough.
6140 */
6142
6143 /*
6144 * If there was a backup label file, it's done its job and the info
6145 * has now been propagated into pg_control. We must get rid of the
6146 * label file so that if we crash during recovery, we'll pick up at
6147 * the latest recovery restartpoint instead of going all the way back
6148 * to the backup start point. It seems prudent though to just rename
6149 * the file out of the way rather than delete it completely.
6150 */
6151 if (haveBackupLabel)
6152 {
6155 }
6156
6157 /*
6158 * If there was a tablespace_map file, it's done its job and the
6159 * symlinks have been created. We must get rid of the map file so
6160 * that if we crash during recovery, we don't create symlinks again.
6161 * It seems prudent though to just rename the file out of the way
6162 * rather than delete it completely.
6163 */
6164 if (haveTblspcMap)
6165 {
6168 }
6169
6170 /*
6171 * Initialize our local copy of minRecoveryPoint. When doing crash
6172 * recovery we want to replay up to the end of WAL. Particularly, in
6173 * the case of a promoted standby minRecoveryPoint value in the
6174 * control file is only updated after the first checkpoint. However,
6175 * if the instance crashes before the first post-recovery checkpoint
6176 * is completed then recovery will use a stale location causing the
6177 * startup process to think that there are still invalid page
6178 * references when checking for data consistency.
6179 */
6181 {
6184 }
6185 else
6186 {
6189 }
6190
6191 /* Check that the GUCs used to generate the WAL allow recovery */
6193
6194 /*
6195 * We're in recovery, so unlogged relations may be trashed and must be
6196 * reset. This should be done BEFORE allowing Hot Standby
6197 * connections, so that read-only backends don't try to read whatever
6198 * garbage is left over from before.
6199 */
6201
6202 /*
6203 * Likewise, delete any saved transaction snapshot files that got left
6204 * behind by crashed backends.
6205 */
6207
6208 /*
6209 * Initialize for Hot Standby, if enabled. We won't let backends in
6210 * yet, not until we've reached the min recovery point specified in
6211 * control file and we've established a recovery snapshot from a
6212 * running-xacts WAL record.
6213 */
6215 {
6216 TransactionId *xids;
6217 int nxids;
6218
6220 (errmsg_internal("initializing for hot standby")));
6221
6223
6224 if (wasShutdown)
6226 else
6227 oldestActiveXID = checkPoint.oldestActiveXid;
6229
6230 /* Tell procarray about the range of xids it has to deal with */
6232
6233 /*
6234 * Startup subtrans only. CLOG, MultiXact and commit timestamp
6235 * have already been started up and other SLRUs are not maintained
6236 * during recovery and need not be started yet.
6237 */
6239
6240 /*
6241 * If we're beginning at a shutdown checkpoint, we know that
6242 * nothing was running on the primary at this point. So fake-up an
6243 * empty running-xacts record and use that here and now. Recover
6244 * additional standby state for prepared transactions.
6245 */
6246 if (wasShutdown)
6247 {
6249 TransactionId latestCompletedXid;
6250
6251 /* Update pg_subtrans entries for any prepared transactions */
6253
6254 /*
6255 * Construct a RunningTransactions snapshot representing a
6256 * shut down server, with only prepared transactions still
6257 * alive. We're never overflowed at this point because all
6258 * subxids are listed with their parent prepared transactions.
6259 */
6260 running.xcnt = nxids;
6261 running.subxcnt = 0;
6263 running.nextXid = XidFromFullTransactionId(checkPoint.nextXid);
6265 latestCompletedXid = XidFromFullTransactionId(checkPoint.nextXid);
6266 TransactionIdRetreat(latestCompletedXid);
6267 Assert(TransactionIdIsNormal(latestCompletedXid));
6268 running.latestCompletedXid = latestCompletedXid;
6269 running.xids = xids;
6270
6272 }
6273 }
6274
6275 /*
6276 * We're all set for replaying the WAL now. Do it.
6277 */
6279 performedWalRecovery = true;
6280 }
6281 else
6282 performedWalRecovery = false;
6283
6284 /*
6285 * Finish WAL recovery.
6286 */
6288 EndOfLog = endOfRecoveryInfo->endOfLog;
6289 EndOfLogTLI = endOfRecoveryInfo->endOfLogTLI;
6290 abortedRecPtr = endOfRecoveryInfo->abortedRecPtr;
6291 missingContrecPtr = endOfRecoveryInfo->missingContrecPtr;
6292
6293 /*
6294 * Reset ps status display, so as no information related to recovery shows
6295 * up.
6296 */
6297 set_ps_display("");
6298
6299 /*
6300 * When recovering from a backup (we are in recovery, and archive recovery
6301 * was requested), complain if we did not roll forward far enough to reach
6302 * the point where the database is consistent. For regular online
6303 * backup-from-primary, that means reaching the end-of-backup WAL record
6304 * (at which point we reset backupStartPoint to be Invalid), for
6305 * backup-from-replica (which can't inject records into the WAL stream),
6306 * that point is when we reach the minRecoveryPoint in pg_control (which
6307 * we purposefully copy last when backing up from a replica). For
6308 * pg_rewind (which creates a backup_label with a method of "pg_rewind")
6309 * or snapshot-style backups (which don't), backupEndRequired will be set
6310 * to false.
6311 *
6312 * Note: it is indeed okay to look at the local variable
6313 * LocalMinRecoveryPoint here, even though ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint
6314 * might be further ahead --- ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint cannot have
6315 * been advanced beyond the WAL we processed.
6316 */
6317 if (InRecovery &&
6320 {
6321 /*
6322 * Ran off end of WAL before reaching end-of-backup WAL record, or
6323 * minRecoveryPoint. That's a bad sign, indicating that you tried to
6324 * recover from an online backup but never called pg_backup_stop(), or
6325 * you didn't archive all the WAL needed.
6326 */
6328 {
6330 ereport(FATAL,
6332 errmsg("WAL ends before end of online backup"),
6333 errhint("All WAL generated while online backup was taken must be available at recovery.")));
6334 else
6335 ereport(FATAL,
6337 errmsg("WAL ends before consistent recovery point")));
6338 }
6339 }
6340
6341 /*
6342 * Reset unlogged relations to the contents of their INIT fork. This is
6343 * done AFTER recovery is complete so as to include any unlogged relations
6344 * created during recovery, but BEFORE recovery is marked as having
6345 * completed successfully. Otherwise we'd not retry if any of the post
6346 * end-of-recovery steps fail.
6347 */
6348 if (InRecovery)
6350
6351 /*
6352 * Pre-scan prepared transactions to find out the range of XIDs present.
6353 * This information is not quite needed yet, but it is positioned here so
6354 * as potential problems are detected before any on-disk change is done.
6355 */
6357
6358 /*
6359 * Allow ordinary WAL segment creation before possibly switching to a new
6360 * timeline, which creates a new segment, and after the last ReadRecord().
6361 */
6363
6364 /*
6365 * Consider whether we need to assign a new timeline ID.
6366 *
6367 * If we did archive recovery, we always assign a new ID. This handles a
6368 * couple of issues. If we stopped short of the end of WAL during
6369 * recovery, then we are clearly generating a new timeline and must assign
6370 * it a unique new ID. Even if we ran to the end, modifying the current
6371 * last segment is problematic because it may result in trying to
6372 * overwrite an already-archived copy of that segment, and we encourage
6373 * DBAs to make their archive_commands reject that. We can dodge the
6374 * problem by making the new active segment have a new timeline ID.
6375 *
6376 * In a normal crash recovery, we can just extend the timeline we were in.
6377 */
6378 newTLI = endOfRecoveryInfo->lastRecTLI;
6380 {
6382 ereport(LOG,
6383 (errmsg("selected new timeline ID: %u", newTLI)));
6384
6385 /*
6386 * Make a writable copy of the last WAL segment. (Note that we also
6387 * have a copy of the last block of the old WAL in
6388 * endOfRecovery->lastPage; we will use that below.)
6389 */
6391
6392 /*
6393 * Remove the signal files out of the way, so that we don't
6394 * accidentally re-enter archive recovery mode in a subsequent crash.
6395 */
6396 if (endOfRecoveryInfo->standby_signal_file_found)
6398
6399 if (endOfRecoveryInfo->recovery_signal_file_found)
6401
6402 /*
6403 * Write the timeline history file, and have it archived. After this
6404 * point (or rather, as soon as the file is archived), the timeline
6405 * will appear as "taken" in the WAL archive and to any standby
6406 * servers. If we crash before actually switching to the new
6407 * timeline, standby servers will nevertheless think that we switched
6408 * to the new timeline, and will try to connect to the new timeline.
6409 * To minimize the window for that, try to do as little as possible
6410 * between here and writing the end-of-recovery record.
6411 */
6413 EndOfLog, endOfRecoveryInfo->recoveryStopReason);
6414
6415 ereport(LOG,
6416 (errmsg("archive recovery complete")));
6417 }
6418
6419 /* Save the selected TimeLineID in shared memory, too */
6424
6425 /*
6426 * Actually, if WAL ended in an incomplete record, skip the parts that
6427 * made it through and start writing after the portion that persisted.
6428 * (It's critical to first write an OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD message, which
6429 * we'll do as soon as we're open for writing new WAL.)
6430 */
6432 {
6433 /*
6434 * We should only have a missingContrecPtr if we're not switching to a
6435 * new timeline. When a timeline switch occurs, WAL is copied from the
6436 * old timeline to the new only up to the end of the last complete
6437 * record, so there can't be an incomplete WAL record that we need to
6438 * disregard.
6439 */
6440 Assert(newTLI == endOfRecoveryInfo->lastRecTLI);
6443 }
6444
6445 /*
6446 * Prepare to write WAL starting at EndOfLog location, and init xlog
6447 * buffer cache using the block containing the last record from the
6448 * previous incarnation.
6449 */
6450 Insert = &XLogCtl->Insert;
6452 Insert->CurrBytePos = XLogRecPtrToBytePos(EndOfLog);
6453
6454 /*
6455 * Tricky point here: lastPage contains the *last* block that the LastRec
6456 * record spans, not the one it starts in. The last block is indeed the
6457 * one we want to use.
6458 */
6459 if (EndOfLog % XLOG_BLCKSZ != 0)
6460 {
6461 char *page;
6462 int len;
6463 int firstIdx;
6464
6466 len = EndOfLog - endOfRecoveryInfo->lastPageBeginPtr;
6468
6469 /* Copy the valid part of the last block, and zero the rest */
6470 page = &XLogCtl->pages[firstIdx * XLOG_BLCKSZ];
6471 memcpy(page, endOfRecoveryInfo->lastPage, len);
6472 memset(page + len, 0, XLOG_BLCKSZ - len);
6473
6476 }
6477 else
6478 {
6479 /*
6480 * There is no partial block to copy. Just set InitializedUpTo, and
6481 * let the first attempt to insert a log record to initialize the next
6482 * buffer.
6483 */
6485 }
6486
6487 /*
6488 * Update local and shared status. This is OK to do without any locks
6489 * because no other process can be reading or writing WAL yet.
6490 */
6497
6498 /*
6499 * Preallocate additional log files, if wanted.
6500 */
6502
6503 /*
6504 * Okay, we're officially UP.
6505 */
6506 InRecovery = false;
6507
6508 /* start the archive_timeout timer and LSN running */
6511
6512 /* also initialize latestCompletedXid, to nextXid - 1 */
6517
6518 /*
6519 * Start up subtrans, if not already done for hot standby. (commit
6520 * timestamps are started below, if necessary.)
6521 */
6524
6525 /*
6526 * Perform end of recovery actions for any SLRUs that need it.
6527 */
6528 TrimCLOG();
6529 TrimMultiXact();
6530
6531 /*
6532 * Reload shared-memory state for prepared transactions. This needs to
6533 * happen before renaming the last partial segment of the old timeline as
6534 * it may be possible that we have to recover some transactions from it.
6535 */
6537
6538 /* Shut down xlogreader */
6540
6541 /* Enable WAL writes for this backend only. */
6543
6544 /* If necessary, write overwrite-contrecord before doing anything else */
6546 {
6549 }
6550
6551 /*
6552 * Update full_page_writes in shared memory and write an XLOG_FPW_CHANGE
6553 * record before resource manager writes cleanup WAL records or checkpoint
6554 * record is written.
6555 */
6556 Insert->fullPageWrites = lastFullPageWrites;
6558
6559 /*
6560 * Emit checkpoint or end-of-recovery record in XLOG, if required.
6561 */
6564
6565 /*
6566 * If any of the critical GUCs have changed, log them before we allow
6567 * backends to write WAL.
6568 */
6570
6571 /* If this is archive recovery, perform post-recovery cleanup actions. */
6574
6575 /*
6576 * Local WAL inserts enabled, so it's time to finish initialization of
6577 * commit timestamp.
6578 */
6580
6581 /*
6582 * Update logical decoding status in shared memory and write an
6583 * XLOG_LOGICAL_DECODING_STATUS_CHANGE, if necessary.
6584 */
6586
6587 /* Clean up EndOfWalRecoveryInfo data to appease Valgrind leak checking */
6588 if (endOfRecoveryInfo->lastPage)
6589 pfree(endOfRecoveryInfo->lastPage);
6590 pfree(endOfRecoveryInfo->recoveryStopReason);
6592
6593 /*
6594 * If we reach this point with checksums in the state inprogress-on, it
6595 * means that data checksums were in the process of being enabled when the
6596 * cluster shut down. Since processing didn't finish, the operation will
6597 * have to be restarted from scratch since there is no capability to
6598 * continue where it was when the cluster shut down. Thus, revert the
6599 * state back to off, and inform the user with a warning message. Being
6600 * able to restart processing is a TODO, but it wouldn't be possible to
6601 * restart here since we cannot launch a dynamic background worker
6602 * directly from here (it has to be from a regular backend).
6603 */
6605 {
6607
6612
6614 errmsg("enabling data checksums was interrupted"),
6615 errhint("Data checksum processing must be manually restarted for checksums to be enabled"));
6616 }
6617
6618 /*
6619 * If data checksums were being disabled when the cluster was shut down,
6620 * we know that we have a state where all backends have stopped validating
6621 * checksums and we can move to off instead of prompting the user to
6622 * perform any action.
6623 */
6625 {
6627
6632 }
6633
6634 /*
6635 * All done with end-of-recovery actions.
6636 *
6637 * Now allow backends to write WAL and update the control file status in
6638 * consequence. SharedRecoveryState, that controls if backends can write
6639 * WAL, is updated while holding ControlFileLock to prevent other backends
6640 * to look at an inconsistent state of the control file in shared memory.
6641 * There is still a small window during which backends can write WAL and
6642 * the control file is still referring to a system not in DB_IN_PRODUCTION
6643 * state while looking at the on-disk control file.
6644 *
6645 * Also, we use info_lck to update SharedRecoveryState to ensure that
6646 * there are no race conditions concerning visibility of other recent
6647 * updates to shared memory.
6648 */
6651
6656
6659
6660 /*
6661 * Wake up the checkpointer process as there might be a request to disable
6662 * logical decoding by concurrent slot drop.
6663 */
6665
6666 /*
6667 * Wake up all waiters. They need to report an error that recovery was
6668 * ended before reaching the target LSN.
6669 */
6673
6674 /*
6675 * Shutdown the recovery environment. This must occur after
6676 * RecoverPreparedTransactions() (see notes in lock_twophase_recover())
6677 * and after switching SharedRecoveryState to RECOVERY_STATE_DONE so as
6678 * any session building a snapshot will not rely on KnownAssignedXids as
6679 * RecoveryInProgress() would return false at this stage. This is
6680 * particularly critical for prepared 2PC transactions, that would still
6681 * need to be included in snapshots once recovery has ended.
6682 */
6685
6686 /*
6687 * If there were cascading standby servers connected to us, nudge any wal
6688 * sender processes to notice that we've been promoted.
6689 */
6690 WalSndWakeup(true, true);
6691
6692 /*
6693 * If this was a promotion, request an (online) checkpoint now. This isn't
6694 * required for consistency, but the last restartpoint might be far back,
6695 * and in case of a crash, recovering from it might take a longer than is
6696 * appropriate now that we're not in standby mode anymore.
6697 */
6698 if (promoted)
6700}
6701
6702/*
6703 * Callback from PerformWalRecovery(), called when we switch from crash
6704 * recovery to archive recovery mode. Updates the control file accordingly.
6705 */
6706void
6708{
6709 /* initialize minRecoveryPoint to this record */
6712 if (ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint < EndRecPtr)
6713 {
6714 ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint = EndRecPtr;
6715 ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI = replayTLI;
6716 }
6717 /* update local copy */
6720
6721 /*
6722 * The startup process can update its local copy of minRecoveryPoint from
6723 * this point.
6724 */
6726
6728
6729 /*
6730 * We update SharedRecoveryState while holding the lock on ControlFileLock
6731 * so both states are consistent in shared memory.
6732 */
6736
6738}
6739
6740/*
6741 * Callback from PerformWalRecovery(), called when we reach the end of backup.
6742 * Updates the control file accordingly.
6743 */
6744void
6746{
6747 /*
6748 * We have reached the end of base backup, as indicated by pg_control. The
6749 * data on disk is now consistent (unless minRecoveryPoint is further
6750 * ahead, which can happen if we crashed during previous recovery). Reset
6751 * backupStartPoint and backupEndPoint, and update minRecoveryPoint to
6752 * make sure we don't allow starting up at an earlier point even if
6753 * recovery is stopped and restarted soon after this.
6754 */
6756
6757 if (ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint < EndRecPtr)
6758 {
6759 ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint = EndRecPtr;
6761 }
6762
6767
6769}
6770
6771/*
6772 * Perform whatever XLOG actions are necessary at end of REDO.
6773 *
6774 * The goal here is to make sure that we'll be able to recover properly if
6775 * we crash again. If we choose to write a checkpoint, we'll write a shutdown
6776 * checkpoint rather than an on-line one. This is not particularly critical,
6777 * but since we may be assigning a new TLI, using a shutdown checkpoint allows
6778 * us to have the rule that TLI only changes in shutdown checkpoints, which
6779 * allows some extra error checking in xlog_redo.
6780 */
6781static bool
6783{
6784 bool promoted = false;
6785
6786 /*
6787 * Perform a checkpoint to update all our recovery activity to disk.
6788 *
6789 * Note that we write a shutdown checkpoint rather than an on-line one.
6790 * This is not particularly critical, but since we may be assigning a new
6791 * TLI, using a shutdown checkpoint allows us to have the rule that TLI
6792 * only changes in shutdown checkpoints, which allows some extra error
6793 * checking in xlog_redo.
6794 *
6795 * In promotion, only create a lightweight end-of-recovery record instead
6796 * of a full checkpoint. A checkpoint is requested later, after we're
6797 * fully out of recovery mode and already accepting queries.
6798 */
6801 {
6802 promoted = true;
6803
6804 /*
6805 * Insert a special WAL record to mark the end of recovery, since we
6806 * aren't doing a checkpoint. That means that the checkpointer process
6807 * may likely be in the middle of a time-smoothed restartpoint and
6808 * could continue to be for minutes after this. That sounds strange,
6809 * but the effect is roughly the same and it would be stranger to try
6810 * to come out of the restartpoint and then checkpoint. We request a
6811 * checkpoint later anyway, just for safety.
6812 */
6814 }
6815 else
6816 {
6820 }
6821
6822 return promoted;
6823}
6824
6825/*
6826 * Is the system still in recovery?
6827 *
6828 * Unlike testing InRecovery, this works in any process that's connected to
6829 * shared memory.
6830 */
6831bool
6833{
6834 /*
6835 * We check shared state each time only until we leave recovery mode. We
6836 * can't re-enter recovery, so there's no need to keep checking after the
6837 * shared variable has once been seen false.
6838 */
6840 return false;
6841 else
6842 {
6843 /*
6844 * use volatile pointer to make sure we make a fresh read of the
6845 * shared variable.
6846 */
6847 volatile XLogCtlData *xlogctl = XLogCtl;
6848
6849 LocalRecoveryInProgress = (xlogctl->SharedRecoveryState != RECOVERY_STATE_DONE);
6850
6851 /*
6852 * Note: We don't need a memory barrier when we're still in recovery.
6853 * We might exit recovery immediately after return, so the caller
6854 * can't rely on 'true' meaning that we're still in recovery anyway.
6855 */
6856
6858 }
6859}
6860
6861/*
6862 * Returns current recovery state from shared memory.
6863 *
6864 * This returned state is kept consistent with the contents of the control
6865 * file. See details about the possible values of RecoveryState in xlog.h.
6866 */
6869{
6870 RecoveryState retval;
6871
6873 retval = XLogCtl->SharedRecoveryState;
6875
6876 return retval;
6877}
6878
6879/*
6880 * Is this process allowed to insert new WAL records?
6881 *
6882 * Ordinarily this is essentially equivalent to !RecoveryInProgress().
6883 * But we also have provisions for forcing the result "true" or "false"
6884 * within specific processes regardless of the global state.
6885 */
6886bool
6888{
6889 /*
6890 * If value is "unconditionally true" or "unconditionally false", just
6891 * return it. This provides the normal fast path once recovery is known
6892 * done.
6893 */
6894 if (LocalXLogInsertAllowed >= 0)
6895 return (bool) LocalXLogInsertAllowed;
6896
6897 /*
6898 * Else, must check to see if we're still in recovery.
6899 */
6900 if (RecoveryInProgress())
6901 return false;
6902
6903 /*
6904 * On exit from recovery, reset to "unconditionally true", since there is
6905 * no need to keep checking.
6906 */
6908 return true;
6909}
6910
6911/*
6912 * Make XLogInsertAllowed() return true in the current process only.
6913 *
6914 * Note: it is allowed to switch LocalXLogInsertAllowed back to -1 later,
6915 * and even call LocalSetXLogInsertAllowed() again after that.
6916 *
6917 * Returns the previous value of LocalXLogInsertAllowed.
6918 */
6919static int
6921{
6923
6925
6926 return oldXLogAllowed;
6927}
6928
6929/*
6930 * Return the current Redo pointer from shared memory.
6931 *
6932 * As a side-effect, the local RedoRecPtr copy is updated.
6933 */
6936{
6937 XLogRecPtr ptr;
6938
6939 /*
6940 * The possibly not up-to-date copy in XLogCtl is enough. Even if we
6941 * grabbed a WAL insertion lock to read the authoritative value in
6942 * Insert->RedoRecPtr, someone might update it just after we've released
6943 * the lock.
6944 */
6946 ptr = XLogCtl->RedoRecPtr;
6948
6949 if (RedoRecPtr < ptr)
6950 RedoRecPtr = ptr;
6951
6952 return RedoRecPtr;
6953}
6954
6955/*
6956 * Return information needed to decide whether a modified block needs a
6957 * full-page image to be included in the WAL record.
6958 *
6959 * The returned values are cached copies from backend-private memory, and
6960 * possibly out-of-date or, indeed, uninitialized, in which case they will
6961 * be InvalidXLogRecPtr and false, respectively. XLogInsertRecord will
6962 * re-check them against up-to-date values, while holding the WAL insert lock.
6963 */
6964void
6970
6971/*
6972 * GetInsertRecPtr -- Returns the current insert position.
6973 *
6974 * NOTE: The value *actually* returned is the position of the last full
6975 * xlog page. It lags behind the real insert position by at most 1 page.
6976 * For that, we don't need to scan through WAL insertion locks, and an
6977 * approximation is enough for the current usage of this function.
6978 */
6981{
6983
6987
6988 return recptr;
6989}
6990
6991/*
6992 * GetFlushRecPtr -- Returns the current flush position, ie, the last WAL
6993 * position known to be fsync'd to disk. This should only be used on a
6994 * system that is known not to be in recovery.
6995 */
6998{
7000
7002
7003 /*
7004 * If we're writing and flushing WAL, the time line can't be changing, so
7005 * no lock is required.
7006 */
7007 if (insertTLI)
7009
7010 return LogwrtResult.Flush;
7011}
7012
7013/*
7014 * GetWALInsertionTimeLine -- Returns the current timeline of a system that
7015 * is not in recovery.
7016 */
7019{
7021
7022 /* Since the value can't be changing, no lock is required. */
7023 return XLogCtl->InsertTimeLineID;
7024}
7025
7026/*
7027 * GetWALInsertionTimeLineIfSet -- If the system is not in recovery, returns
7028 * the WAL insertion timeline; else, returns 0. Wherever possible, use
7029 * GetWALInsertionTimeLine() instead, since it's cheaper. Note that this
7030 * function decides recovery has ended as soon as the insert TLI is set, which
7031 * happens before we set XLogCtl->SharedRecoveryState to RECOVERY_STATE_DONE.
7032 */
7044
7045/*
7046 * GetLastImportantRecPtr -- Returns the LSN of the last important record
7047 * inserted. All records not explicitly marked as unimportant are considered
7048 * important.
7049 *
7050 * The LSN is determined by computing the maximum of
7051 * WALInsertLocks[i].lastImportantAt.
7052 */
7055{
7057 int i;
7058
7059 for (i = 0; i < NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS; i++)
7060 {
7062
7063 /*
7064 * Need to take a lock to prevent torn reads of the LSN, which are
7065 * possible on some of the supported platforms. WAL insert locks only
7066 * support exclusive mode, so we have to use that.
7067 */
7070 LWLockRelease(&WALInsertLocks[i].l.lock);
7071
7072 if (res < last_important)
7073 res = last_important;
7074 }
7075
7076 return res;
7077}
7078
7079/*
7080 * Get the time and LSN of the last xlog segment switch
7081 */
7084{
7086
7087 /* Need WALWriteLock, but shared lock is sufficient */
7092
7093 return result;
7094}
7095
7096/*
7097 * This must be called ONCE during postmaster or standalone-backend shutdown
7098 */
7099void
7101{
7102 /*
7103 * We should have an aux process resource owner to use, and we should not
7104 * be in a transaction that's installed some other resowner.
7105 */
7110
7111 /* Don't be chatty in standalone mode */
7113 (errmsg("shutting down")));
7114
7115 /*
7116 * Signal walsenders to move to stopping state.
7117 */
7119
7120 /*
7121 * Wait for WAL senders to be in stopping state. This prevents commands
7122 * from writing new WAL.
7123 */
7125
7126 if (RecoveryInProgress())
7128 else
7129 {
7130 /*
7131 * If archiving is enabled, rotate the last XLOG file so that all the
7132 * remaining records are archived (postmaster wakes up the archiver
7133 * process one more time at the end of shutdown). The checkpoint
7134 * record will go to the next XLOG file and won't be archived (yet).
7135 */
7136 if (XLogArchivingActive())
7137 RequestXLogSwitch(false);
7138
7140 }
7141}
7142
7143/*
7144 * Format checkpoint request flags as a space-separated string for
7145 * log messages.
7146 */
7147static const char *
7149{
7150 static char buf[128];
7151
7152 snprintf(buf, sizeof(buf), "%s%s%s%s%s%s%s%s",
7153 (flags & CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN) ? " shutdown" : "",
7154 (flags & CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY) ? " end-of-recovery" : "",
7155 (flags & CHECKPOINT_FAST) ? " fast" : "",
7156 (flags & CHECKPOINT_FORCE) ? " force" : "",
7157 (flags & CHECKPOINT_WAIT) ? " wait" : "",
7158 (flags & CHECKPOINT_CAUSE_XLOG) ? " wal" : "",
7159 (flags & CHECKPOINT_CAUSE_TIME) ? " time" : "",
7160 (flags & CHECKPOINT_FLUSH_UNLOGGED) ? " flush-unlogged" : "");
7161
7162 return buf;
7163}
7164
7165/*
7166 * Log start of a checkpoint.
7167 */
7168static void
7170{
7171 if (restartpoint)
7172 ereport(LOG,
7173 /* translator: the placeholder shows checkpoint options */
7174 (errmsg("restartpoint starting:%s",
7175 CheckpointFlagsString(flags))));
7176 else
7177 ereport(LOG,
7178 /* translator: the placeholder shows checkpoint options */
7179 (errmsg("checkpoint starting:%s",
7180 CheckpointFlagsString(flags))));
7181}
7182
7183/*
7184 * Log end of a checkpoint.
7185 */
7186static void
7188{
7189 long write_msecs,
7190 sync_msecs,
7195
7197
7200
7203
7204 /* Accumulate checkpoint timing summary data, in milliseconds. */
7207
7208 /*
7209 * All of the published timing statistics are accounted for. Only
7210 * continue if a log message is to be written.
7211 */
7212 if (!log_checkpoints)
7213 return;
7214
7217
7218 /*
7219 * Timing values returned from CheckpointStats are in microseconds.
7220 * Convert to milliseconds for consistent printing.
7221 */
7223
7228 average_msecs = (long) ((average_sync_time + 999) / 1000);
7229
7230 /*
7231 * ControlFileLock is not required to see ControlFile->checkPoint and
7232 * ->checkPointCopy here as we are the only updator of those variables at
7233 * this moment.
7234 */
7235 if (restartpoint)
7236 ereport(LOG,
7237 (errmsg("restartpoint complete:%s: wrote %d buffers (%.1f%%), "
7238 "wrote %d SLRU buffers; %d WAL file(s) added, "
7239 "%d removed, %d recycled; write=%ld.%03d s, "
7240 "sync=%ld.%03d s, total=%ld.%03d s; sync files=%d, "
7241 "longest=%ld.%03d s, average=%ld.%03d s; distance=%d kB, "
7242 "estimate=%d kB; lsn=%X/%08X, redo lsn=%X/%08X",
7243 CheckpointFlagsString(flags),
7250 write_msecs / 1000, (int) (write_msecs % 1000),
7251 sync_msecs / 1000, (int) (sync_msecs % 1000),
7252 total_msecs / 1000, (int) (total_msecs % 1000),
7254 longest_msecs / 1000, (int) (longest_msecs % 1000),
7255 average_msecs / 1000, (int) (average_msecs % 1000),
7256 (int) (PrevCheckPointDistance / 1024.0),
7257 (int) (CheckPointDistanceEstimate / 1024.0),
7260 else
7261 ereport(LOG,
7262 (errmsg("checkpoint complete:%s: wrote %d buffers (%.1f%%), "
7263 "wrote %d SLRU buffers; %d WAL file(s) added, "
7264 "%d removed, %d recycled; write=%ld.%03d s, "
7265 "sync=%ld.%03d s, total=%ld.%03d s; sync files=%d, "
7266 "longest=%ld.%03d s, average=%ld.%03d s; distance=%d kB, "
7267 "estimate=%d kB; lsn=%X/%08X, redo lsn=%X/%08X",
7268 CheckpointFlagsString(flags),
7275 write_msecs / 1000, (int) (write_msecs % 1000),
7276 sync_msecs / 1000, (int) (sync_msecs % 1000),
7277 total_msecs / 1000, (int) (total_msecs % 1000),
7279 longest_msecs / 1000, (int) (longest_msecs % 1000),
7280 average_msecs / 1000, (int) (average_msecs % 1000),
7281 (int) (PrevCheckPointDistance / 1024.0),
7282 (int) (CheckPointDistanceEstimate / 1024.0),
7285}
7286
7287/*
7288 * Update the estimate of distance between checkpoints.
7289 *
7290 * The estimate is used to calculate the number of WAL segments to keep
7291 * preallocated, see XLOGfileslop().
7292 */
7293static void
7295{
7296 /*
7297 * To estimate the number of segments consumed between checkpoints, keep a
7298 * moving average of the amount of WAL generated in previous checkpoint
7299 * cycles. However, if the load is bursty, with quiet periods and busy
7300 * periods, we want to cater for the peak load. So instead of a plain
7301 * moving average, let the average decline slowly if the previous cycle
7302 * used less WAL than estimated, but bump it up immediately if it used
7303 * more.
7304 *
7305 * When checkpoints are triggered by max_wal_size, this should converge to
7306 * CheckpointSegments * wal_segment_size,
7307 *
7308 * Note: This doesn't pay any attention to what caused the checkpoint.
7309 * Checkpoints triggered manually with CHECKPOINT command, or by e.g.
7310 * starting a base backup, are counted the same as those created
7311 * automatically. The slow-decline will largely mask them out, if they are
7312 * not frequent. If they are frequent, it seems reasonable to count them
7313 * in as any others; if you issue a manual checkpoint every 5 minutes and
7314 * never let a timed checkpoint happen, it makes sense to base the
7315 * preallocation on that 5 minute interval rather than whatever
7316 * checkpoint_timeout is set to.
7317 */
7318 PrevCheckPointDistance = nbytes;
7319 if (CheckPointDistanceEstimate < nbytes)
7321 else
7323 (0.90 * CheckPointDistanceEstimate + 0.10 * (double) nbytes);
7324}
7325
7326/*
7327 * Update the ps display for a process running a checkpoint. Note that
7328 * this routine should not do any allocations so as it can be called
7329 * from a critical section.
7330 */
7331static void
7333{
7334 /*
7335 * The status is reported only for end-of-recovery and shutdown
7336 * checkpoints or shutdown restartpoints. Updating the ps display is
7337 * useful in those situations as it may not be possible to rely on
7338 * pg_stat_activity to see the status of the checkpointer or the startup
7339 * process.
7340 */
7342 return;
7343
7344 if (reset)
7345 set_ps_display("");
7346 else
7347 {
7348 char activitymsg[128];
7349
7350 snprintf(activitymsg, sizeof(activitymsg), "performing %s%s%s",
7351 (flags & CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY) ? "end-of-recovery " : "",
7352 (flags & CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN) ? "shutdown " : "",
7353 restartpoint ? "restartpoint" : "checkpoint");
7355 }
7356}
7357
7358
7359/*
7360 * Perform a checkpoint --- either during shutdown, or on-the-fly
7361 *
7362 * flags is a bitwise OR of the following:
7363 * CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN: checkpoint is for database shutdown.
7364 * CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY: checkpoint is for end of WAL recovery.
7365 * CHECKPOINT_FAST: finish the checkpoint ASAP, ignoring
7366 * checkpoint_completion_target parameter.
7367 * CHECKPOINT_FORCE: force a checkpoint even if no XLOG activity has occurred
7368 * since the last one (implied by CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN or
7369 * CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY).
7370 * CHECKPOINT_FLUSH_UNLOGGED: also flush buffers of unlogged tables.
7371 *
7372 * Note: flags contains other bits, of interest here only for logging purposes.
7373 * In particular note that this routine is synchronous and does not pay
7374 * attention to CHECKPOINT_WAIT.
7375 *
7376 * If !shutdown then we are writing an online checkpoint. An XLOG_CHECKPOINT_REDO
7377 * record is inserted into WAL at the logical location of the checkpoint, before
7378 * flushing anything to disk, and when the checkpoint is eventually completed,
7379 * and it is from this point that WAL replay will begin in the case of a recovery
7380 * from this checkpoint. Once everything is written to disk, an
7381 * XLOG_CHECKPOINT_ONLINE record is written to complete the checkpoint, and
7382 * points back to the earlier XLOG_CHECKPOINT_REDO record. This mechanism allows
7383 * other write-ahead log records to be written while the checkpoint is in
7384 * progress, but we must be very careful about order of operations. This function
7385 * may take many minutes to execute on a busy system.
7386 *
7387 * On the other hand, when shutdown is true, concurrent insertion into the
7388 * write-ahead log is impossible, so there is no need for two separate records.
7389 * In this case, we only insert an XLOG_CHECKPOINT_SHUTDOWN record, and it's
7390 * both the record marking the completion of the checkpoint and the location
7391 * from which WAL replay would begin if needed.
7392 *
7393 * Returns true if a new checkpoint was performed, or false if it was skipped
7394 * because the system was idle.
7395 */
7396bool
7398{
7399 bool shutdown;
7400 CheckPoint checkPoint;
7404 uint32 freespace;
7408 int nvxids;
7409 int oldXLogAllowed = 0;
7410
7411 /*
7412 * An end-of-recovery checkpoint is really a shutdown checkpoint, just
7413 * issued at a different time.
7414 */
7416 shutdown = true;
7417 else
7418 shutdown = false;
7419
7420 /* sanity check */
7421 if (RecoveryInProgress() && (flags & CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY) == 0)
7422 elog(ERROR, "can't create a checkpoint during recovery");
7423
7424 /*
7425 * Prepare to accumulate statistics.
7426 *
7427 * Note: because it is possible for log_checkpoints to change while a
7428 * checkpoint proceeds, we always accumulate stats, even if
7429 * log_checkpoints is currently off.
7430 */
7433
7434 /*
7435 * Let smgr prepare for checkpoint; this has to happen outside the
7436 * critical section and before we determine the REDO pointer. Note that
7437 * smgr must not do anything that'd have to be undone if we decide no
7438 * checkpoint is needed.
7439 */
7441
7442 /* Run these points outside the critical section. */
7443 INJECTION_POINT("create-checkpoint-initial", NULL);
7444 INJECTION_POINT_LOAD("create-checkpoint-run");
7445
7446 /*
7447 * Use a critical section to force system panic if we have trouble.
7448 */
7450
7451 if (shutdown)
7452 {
7457 }
7458
7459 /* Begin filling in the checkpoint WAL record */
7460 MemSet(&checkPoint, 0, sizeof(checkPoint));
7461 checkPoint.time = (pg_time_t) time(NULL);
7462
7463 /*
7464 * For Hot Standby, derive the oldestActiveXid before we fix the redo
7465 * pointer. This allows us to begin accumulating changes to assemble our
7466 * starting snapshot of locks and transactions.
7467 */
7469 checkPoint.oldestActiveXid = GetOldestActiveTransactionId(false, true);
7470 else
7472
7473 /*
7474 * Get location of last important record before acquiring insert locks (as
7475 * GetLastImportantRecPtr() also locks WAL locks).
7476 */
7478
7479 /*
7480 * If this isn't a shutdown or forced checkpoint, and if there has been no
7481 * WAL activity requiring a checkpoint, skip it. The idea here is to
7482 * avoid inserting duplicate checkpoints when the system is idle.
7483 */
7485 CHECKPOINT_FORCE)) == 0)
7486 {
7488 {
7491 (errmsg_internal("checkpoint skipped because system is idle")));
7492 return false;
7493 }
7494 }
7495
7496 /*
7497 * An end-of-recovery checkpoint is created before anyone is allowed to
7498 * write WAL. To allow us to write the checkpoint record, temporarily
7499 * enable XLogInsertAllowed.
7500 */
7501 if (flags & CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY)
7503
7505 if (flags & CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY)
7507 else
7508 checkPoint.PrevTimeLineID = checkPoint.ThisTimeLineID;
7509
7510 /*
7511 * We must block concurrent insertions while examining insert state.
7512 */
7514
7515 checkPoint.fullPageWrites = Insert->fullPageWrites;
7516 checkPoint.wal_level = wal_level;
7517
7518 /*
7519 * Get the current data_checksum_version value from xlogctl, valid at the
7520 * time of the checkpoint.
7521 */
7525
7526 if (shutdown)
7527 {
7529
7530 /*
7531 * Compute new REDO record ptr = location of next XLOG record.
7532 *
7533 * Since this is a shutdown checkpoint, there can't be any concurrent
7534 * WAL insertion.
7535 */
7536 freespace = INSERT_FREESPACE(curInsert);
7537 if (freespace == 0)
7538 {
7541 else
7543 }
7544 checkPoint.redo = curInsert;
7545
7546 /*
7547 * Here we update the shared RedoRecPtr for future XLogInsert calls;
7548 * this must be done while holding all the insertion locks.
7549 *
7550 * Note: if we fail to complete the checkpoint, RedoRecPtr will be
7551 * left pointing past where it really needs to point. This is okay;
7552 * the only consequence is that XLogInsert might back up whole buffers
7553 * that it didn't really need to. We can't postpone advancing
7554 * RedoRecPtr because XLogInserts that happen while we are dumping
7555 * buffers must assume that their buffer changes are not included in
7556 * the checkpoint.
7557 */
7558 RedoRecPtr = XLogCtl->Insert.RedoRecPtr = checkPoint.redo;
7559 }
7560
7561 /*
7562 * Now we can release the WAL insertion locks, allowing other xacts to
7563 * proceed while we are flushing disk buffers.
7564 */
7566
7567 /*
7568 * If this is an online checkpoint, we have not yet determined the redo
7569 * point. We do so now by inserting the special XLOG_CHECKPOINT_REDO
7570 * record; the LSN at which it starts becomes the new redo pointer. We
7571 * don't do this for a shutdown checkpoint, because in that case no WAL
7572 * can be written between the redo point and the insertion of the
7573 * checkpoint record itself, so the checkpoint record itself serves to
7574 * mark the redo point.
7575 */
7576 if (!shutdown)
7577 {
7579
7581 redo_rec.wal_level = wal_level;
7583 redo_rec.data_checksum_version = XLogCtl->data_checksum_version;
7586
7587 /* Include WAL level in record for WAL summarizer's benefit. */
7591
7592 /*
7593 * XLogInsertRecord will have updated XLogCtl->Insert.RedoRecPtr in
7594 * shared memory and RedoRecPtr in backend-local memory, but we need
7595 * to copy that into the record that will be inserted when the
7596 * checkpoint is complete.
7597 */
7598 checkPoint.redo = RedoRecPtr;
7599 }
7600
7601 /* Update the info_lck-protected copy of RedoRecPtr as well */
7603 XLogCtl->RedoRecPtr = checkPoint.redo;
7605
7606 /*
7607 * If enabled, log checkpoint start. We postpone this until now so as not
7608 * to log anything if we decided to skip the checkpoint.
7609 */
7610 if (log_checkpoints)
7611 LogCheckpointStart(flags, false);
7612
7613 INJECTION_POINT_CACHED("create-checkpoint-run", NULL);
7614
7615 /* Update the process title */
7616 update_checkpoint_display(flags, false, false);
7617
7619
7620 /*
7621 * Get the other info we need for the checkpoint record.
7622 *
7623 * We don't need to save oldestClogXid in the checkpoint, it only matters
7624 * for the short period in which clog is being truncated, and if we crash
7625 * during that we'll redo the clog truncation and fix up oldestClogXid
7626 * there.
7627 */
7629 checkPoint.nextXid = TransamVariables->nextXid;
7630 checkPoint.oldestXid = TransamVariables->oldestXid;
7633
7638
7640 checkPoint.nextOid = TransamVariables->nextOid;
7641 if (!shutdown)
7642 checkPoint.nextOid += TransamVariables->oidCount;
7644
7646
7648 &checkPoint.nextMulti,
7649 &checkPoint.nextMultiOffset,
7650 &checkPoint.oldestMulti,
7651 &checkPoint.oldestMultiDB);
7652
7653 /*
7654 * Having constructed the checkpoint record, ensure all shmem disk buffers
7655 * and commit-log buffers are flushed to disk.
7656 *
7657 * This I/O could fail for various reasons. If so, we will fail to
7658 * complete the checkpoint, but there is no reason to force a system
7659 * panic. Accordingly, exit critical section while doing it.
7660 */
7662
7663 /*
7664 * In some cases there are groups of actions that must all occur on one
7665 * side or the other of a checkpoint record. Before flushing the
7666 * checkpoint record we must explicitly wait for any backend currently
7667 * performing those groups of actions.
7668 *
7669 * One example is end of transaction, so we must wait for any transactions
7670 * that are currently in commit critical sections. If an xact inserted
7671 * its commit record into XLOG just before the REDO point, then a crash
7672 * restart from the REDO point would not replay that record, which means
7673 * that our flushing had better include the xact's update of pg_xact. So
7674 * we wait till he's out of his commit critical section before proceeding.
7675 * See notes in RecordTransactionCommit().
7676 *
7677 * Because we've already released the insertion locks, this test is a bit
7678 * fuzzy: it is possible that we will wait for xacts we didn't really need
7679 * to wait for. But the delay should be short and it seems better to make
7680 * checkpoint take a bit longer than to hold off insertions longer than
7681 * necessary. (In fact, the whole reason we have this issue is that xact.c
7682 * does commit record XLOG insertion and clog update as two separate steps
7683 * protected by different locks, but again that seems best on grounds of
7684 * minimizing lock contention.)
7685 *
7686 * A transaction that has not yet set delayChkptFlags when we look cannot
7687 * be at risk, since it has not inserted its commit record yet; and one
7688 * that's already cleared it is not at risk either, since it's done fixing
7689 * clog and we will correctly flush the update below. So we cannot miss
7690 * any xacts we need to wait for.
7691 */
7693 if (nvxids > 0)
7694 {
7695 do
7696 {
7697 /*
7698 * Keep absorbing fsync requests while we wait. There could even
7699 * be a deadlock if we don't, if the process that prevents the
7700 * checkpoint is trying to add a request to the queue.
7701 */
7703
7705 pg_usleep(10000L); /* wait for 10 msec */
7709 }
7710 pfree(vxids);
7711
7712 CheckPointGuts(checkPoint.redo, flags);
7713
7715 if (nvxids > 0)
7716 {
7717 do
7718 {
7720
7722 pg_usleep(10000L); /* wait for 10 msec */
7726 }
7727 pfree(vxids);
7728
7729 /*
7730 * Take a snapshot of running transactions and write this to WAL. This
7731 * allows us to reconstruct the state of running transactions during
7732 * archive recovery, if required. Skip, if this info disabled.
7733 *
7734 * If we are shutting down, or Startup process is completing crash
7735 * recovery we don't need to write running xact data.
7736 */
7739
7741
7742 /*
7743 * Now insert the checkpoint record into XLOG.
7744 */
7746 XLogRegisterData(&checkPoint, sizeof(checkPoint));
7750
7752
7753 /*
7754 * We mustn't write any new WAL after a shutdown checkpoint, or it will be
7755 * overwritten at next startup. No-one should even try, this just allows
7756 * sanity-checking. In the case of an end-of-recovery checkpoint, we want
7757 * to just temporarily disable writing until the system has exited
7758 * recovery.
7759 */
7760 if (shutdown)
7761 {
7762 if (flags & CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY)
7764 else
7765 LocalXLogInsertAllowed = 0; /* never again write WAL */
7766 }
7767
7768 /*
7769 * We now have ProcLastRecPtr = start of actual checkpoint record, recptr
7770 * = end of actual checkpoint record.
7771 */
7772 if (shutdown && checkPoint.redo != ProcLastRecPtr)
7773 ereport(PANIC,
7774 (errmsg("concurrent write-ahead log activity while database system is shutting down")));
7775
7776 /*
7777 * Remember the prior checkpoint's redo ptr for
7778 * UpdateCheckPointDistanceEstimate()
7779 */
7781
7782 /*
7783 * Update the control file.
7784 */
7786 if (shutdown)
7789 ControlFile->checkPointCopy = checkPoint;
7790 /* crash recovery should always recover to the end of WAL */
7793
7794 /*
7795 * Persist unloggedLSN value. It's reset on crash recovery, so this goes
7796 * unused on non-shutdown checkpoints, but seems useful to store it always
7797 * for debugging purposes.
7798 */
7800
7803
7804 /*
7805 * We are now done with critical updates; no need for system panic if we
7806 * have trouble while fooling with old log segments.
7807 */
7809
7810 /*
7811 * WAL summaries end when the next XLOG_CHECKPOINT_REDO or
7812 * XLOG_CHECKPOINT_SHUTDOWN record is reached. This is the first point
7813 * where (a) we're not inside of a critical section and (b) we can be
7814 * certain that the relevant record has been flushed to disk, which must
7815 * happen before it can be summarized.
7816 *
7817 * If this is a shutdown checkpoint, then this happens reasonably
7818 * promptly: we've only just inserted and flushed the
7819 * XLOG_CHECKPOINT_SHUTDOWN record. If this is not a shutdown checkpoint,
7820 * then this might not be very prompt at all: the XLOG_CHECKPOINT_REDO
7821 * record was written before we began flushing data to disk, and that
7822 * could be many minutes ago at this point. However, we don't XLogFlush()
7823 * after inserting that record, so we're not guaranteed that it's on disk
7824 * until after the above call that flushes the XLOG_CHECKPOINT_ONLINE
7825 * record.
7826 */
7828
7829 /*
7830 * Let smgr do post-checkpoint cleanup (eg, deleting old files).
7831 */
7833
7834 /*
7835 * Update the average distance between checkpoints if the prior checkpoint
7836 * exists.
7837 */
7840
7841 INJECTION_POINT("checkpoint-before-old-wal-removal", NULL);
7842
7843 /*
7844 * Delete old log files, those no longer needed for last checkpoint to
7845 * prevent the disk holding the xlog from growing full.
7846 */
7852 {
7853 /*
7854 * Some slots have been invalidated; recalculate the old-segment
7855 * horizon, starting again from RedoRecPtr.
7856 */
7859 }
7860 _logSegNo--;
7862 checkPoint.ThisTimeLineID);
7863
7864 /*
7865 * Make more log segments if needed. (Do this after recycling old log
7866 * segments, since that may supply some of the needed files.)
7867 */
7868 if (!shutdown)
7870
7871 /*
7872 * Truncate pg_subtrans if possible. We can throw away all data before
7873 * the oldest XMIN of any running transaction. No future transaction will
7874 * attempt to reference any pg_subtrans entry older than that (see Asserts
7875 * in subtrans.c). During recovery, though, we mustn't do this because
7876 * StartupSUBTRANS hasn't been called yet.
7877 */
7878 if (!RecoveryInProgress())
7880
7881 /* Real work is done; log and update stats. */
7882 LogCheckpointEnd(false, flags);
7883
7884 /* Reset the process title */
7885 update_checkpoint_display(flags, false, true);
7886
7888 NBuffers,
7892
7893 return true;
7894}
7895
7896/*
7897 * Mark the end of recovery in WAL though without running a full checkpoint.
7898 * We can expect that a restartpoint is likely to be in progress as we
7899 * do this, though we are unwilling to wait for it to complete.
7900 *
7901 * CreateRestartPoint() allows for the case where recovery may end before
7902 * the restartpoint completes so there is no concern of concurrent behaviour.
7903 */
7904static void
7906{
7909
7910 /* sanity check */
7911 if (!RecoveryInProgress())
7912 elog(ERROR, "can only be used to end recovery");
7913
7914 xlrec.end_time = GetCurrentTimestamp();
7915 xlrec.wal_level = wal_level;
7916
7918 xlrec.ThisTimeLineID = XLogCtl->InsertTimeLineID;
7919 xlrec.PrevTimeLineID = XLogCtl->PrevTimeLineID;
7921
7923
7927
7929
7930 /*
7931 * Update the control file so that crash recovery can follow the timeline
7932 * changes to this point.
7933 */
7936 ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI = xlrec.ThisTimeLineID;
7937
7938 /* start with the latest checksum version (as of the end of recovery) */
7942
7945
7947}
7948
7949/*
7950 * Write an OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD message.
7951 *
7952 * When on WAL replay we expect a continuation record at the start of a page
7953 * that is not there, recovery ends and WAL writing resumes at that point.
7954 * But it's wrong to resume writing new WAL back at the start of the record
7955 * that was broken, because downstream consumers of that WAL (physical
7956 * replicas) are not prepared to "rewind". So the first action after
7957 * finishing replay of all valid WAL must be to write a record of this type
7958 * at the point where the contrecord was missing; to support xlogreader
7959 * detecting the special case, XLP_FIRST_IS_OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD is also added
7960 * to the page header where the record occurs. xlogreader has an ad-hoc
7961 * mechanism to report metadata about the broken record, which is what we
7962 * use here.
7963 *
7964 * At replay time, XLP_FIRST_IS_OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD instructs xlogreader to
7965 * skip the record it was reading, and pass back the LSN of the skipped
7966 * record, so that its caller can verify (on "replay" of that record) that the
7967 * XLOG_OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD matches what was effectively overwritten.
7968 *
7969 * 'aborted_lsn' is the beginning position of the record that was incomplete.
7970 * It is included in the WAL record. 'pagePtr' and 'newTLI' point to the
7971 * beginning of the XLOG page where the record is to be inserted. They must
7972 * match the current WAL insert position, they're passed here just so that we
7973 * can verify that.
7974 */
7975static XLogRecPtr
7978{
7983
7984 /* sanity checks */
7985 if (!RecoveryInProgress())
7986 elog(ERROR, "can only be used at end of recovery");
7987 if (pagePtr % XLOG_BLCKSZ != 0)
7988 elog(ERROR, "invalid position for missing continuation record %X/%08X",
7990
7991 /* The current WAL insert position should be right after the page header */
7992 startPos = pagePtr;
7995 else
7998 if (recptr != startPos)
7999 elog(ERROR, "invalid WAL insert position %X/%08X for OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD",
8001
8003
8004 /*
8005 * Initialize the XLOG page header (by GetXLogBuffer), and set the
8006 * XLP_FIRST_IS_OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD flag.
8007 *
8008 * No other backend is allowed to write WAL yet, so acquiring the WAL
8009 * insertion lock is just pro forma.
8010 */
8015
8016 /*
8017 * Insert the XLOG_OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD record as the first record on the
8018 * page. We know it becomes the first record, because no other backend is
8019 * allowed to write WAL yet.
8020 */
8022 xlrec.overwritten_lsn = aborted_lsn;
8023 xlrec.overwrite_time = GetCurrentTimestamp();
8026
8027 /* check that the record was inserted to the right place */
8028 if (ProcLastRecPtr != startPos)
8029 elog(ERROR, "OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD was inserted to unexpected position %X/%08X",
8031
8033
8035
8036 return recptr;
8037}
8038
8039/*
8040 * Flush all data in shared memory to disk, and fsync
8041 *
8042 * This is the common code shared between regular checkpoints and
8043 * recovery restartpoints.
8044 */
8045static void
8047{
8053
8054 /* Write out all dirty data in SLRUs and the main buffer pool */
8062 CheckPointBuffers(flags);
8063
8064 /* Perform all queued up fsyncs */
8070
8071 /* We deliberately delay 2PC checkpointing as long as possible */
8073}
8074
8075/*
8076 * Save a checkpoint for recovery restart if appropriate
8077 *
8078 * This function is called each time a checkpoint record is read from XLOG.
8079 * It must determine whether the checkpoint represents a safe restartpoint or
8080 * not. If so, the checkpoint record is stashed in shared memory so that
8081 * CreateRestartPoint can consult it. (Note that the latter function is
8082 * executed by the checkpointer, while this one will be executed by the
8083 * startup process.)
8084 */
8085static void
8087{
8088 /*
8089 * Also refrain from creating a restartpoint if we have seen any
8090 * references to non-existent pages. Restarting recovery from the
8091 * restartpoint would not see the references, so we would lose the
8092 * cross-check that the pages belonged to a relation that was dropped
8093 * later.
8094 */
8096 {
8097 elog(DEBUG2,
8098 "could not record restart point at %X/%08X because there are unresolved references to invalid pages",
8099 LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(checkPoint->redo));
8100 return;
8101 }
8102
8103 /*
8104 * Copy the checkpoint record to shared memory, so that checkpointer can
8105 * work out the next time it wants to perform a restartpoint.
8106 */
8110 XLogCtl->lastCheckPoint = *checkPoint;
8112}
8113
8114/*
8115 * Establish a restartpoint if possible.
8116 *
8117 * This is similar to CreateCheckPoint, but is used during WAL recovery
8118 * to establish a point from which recovery can roll forward without
8119 * replaying the entire recovery log.
8120 *
8121 * Returns true if a new restartpoint was established. We can only establish
8122 * a restartpoint if we have replayed a safe checkpoint record since last
8123 * restartpoint.
8124 */
8125bool
8127{
8128 XLogRecPtr lastCheckPointRecPtr;
8129 XLogRecPtr lastCheckPointEndPtr;
8130 CheckPoint lastCheckPoint;
8134 TimeLineID replayTLI;
8135 XLogRecPtr endptr;
8138
8139 /* Concurrent checkpoint/restartpoint cannot happen */
8141
8142 /* Get a local copy of the last safe checkpoint record. */
8144 lastCheckPointRecPtr = XLogCtl->lastCheckPointRecPtr;
8145 lastCheckPointEndPtr = XLogCtl->lastCheckPointEndPtr;
8146 lastCheckPoint = XLogCtl->lastCheckPoint;
8148
8149 /*
8150 * Check that we're still in recovery mode. It's ok if we exit recovery
8151 * mode after this check, the restart point is valid anyway.
8152 */
8153 if (!RecoveryInProgress())
8154 {
8156 (errmsg_internal("skipping restartpoint, recovery has already ended")));
8157 return false;
8158 }
8159
8160 /*
8161 * If the last checkpoint record we've replayed is already our last
8162 * restartpoint, we can't perform a new restart point. We still update
8163 * minRecoveryPoint in that case, so that if this is a shutdown restart
8164 * point, we won't start up earlier than before. That's not strictly
8165 * necessary, but when hot standby is enabled, it would be rather weird if
8166 * the database opened up for read-only connections at a point-in-time
8167 * before the last shutdown. Such time travel is still possible in case of
8168 * immediate shutdown, though.
8169 *
8170 * We don't explicitly advance minRecoveryPoint when we do create a
8171 * restartpoint. It's assumed that flushing the buffers will do that as a
8172 * side-effect.
8173 */
8174 if (!XLogRecPtrIsValid(lastCheckPointRecPtr) ||
8175 lastCheckPoint.redo <= ControlFile->checkPointCopy.redo)
8176 {
8178 errmsg_internal("skipping restartpoint, already performed at %X/%08X",
8179 LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(lastCheckPoint.redo)));
8180
8182 if (flags & CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN)
8183 {
8188 }
8189 return false;
8190 }
8191
8192 /*
8193 * Update the shared RedoRecPtr so that the startup process can calculate
8194 * the number of segments replayed since last restartpoint, and request a
8195 * restartpoint if it exceeds CheckPointSegments.
8196 *
8197 * Like in CreateCheckPoint(), hold off insertions to update it, although
8198 * during recovery this is just pro forma, because no WAL insertions are
8199 * happening.
8200 */
8202 RedoRecPtr = XLogCtl->Insert.RedoRecPtr = lastCheckPoint.redo;
8204
8205 /* Also update the info_lck-protected copy */
8207 XLogCtl->RedoRecPtr = lastCheckPoint.redo;
8209
8210 /*
8211 * Prepare to accumulate statistics.
8212 *
8213 * Note: because it is possible for log_checkpoints to change while a
8214 * checkpoint proceeds, we always accumulate stats, even if
8215 * log_checkpoints is currently off.
8216 */
8219
8220 if (log_checkpoints)
8221 LogCheckpointStart(flags, true);
8222
8223 /* Update the process title */
8224 update_checkpoint_display(flags, true, false);
8225
8226 CheckPointGuts(lastCheckPoint.redo, flags);
8227
8228 /*
8229 * This location needs to be after CheckPointGuts() to ensure that some
8230 * work has already happened during this checkpoint.
8231 */
8232 INJECTION_POINT("create-restart-point", NULL);
8233
8234 /*
8235 * Remember the prior checkpoint's redo ptr for
8236 * UpdateCheckPointDistanceEstimate()
8237 */
8239
8240 /*
8241 * Update pg_control, using current time. Check that it still shows an
8242 * older checkpoint, else do nothing; this is a quick hack to make sure
8243 * nothing really bad happens if somehow we get here after the
8244 * end-of-recovery checkpoint.
8245 */
8247 if (ControlFile->checkPointCopy.redo < lastCheckPoint.redo)
8248 {
8249 /*
8250 * Update the checkpoint information. We do this even if the cluster
8251 * does not show DB_IN_ARCHIVE_RECOVERY to match with the set of WAL
8252 * segments recycled below.
8253 */
8254 ControlFile->checkPoint = lastCheckPointRecPtr;
8255 ControlFile->checkPointCopy = lastCheckPoint;
8256
8257 /*
8258 * Ensure minRecoveryPoint is past the checkpoint record and update it
8259 * if the control file still shows DB_IN_ARCHIVE_RECOVERY. Normally,
8260 * this will have happened already while writing out dirty buffers,
8261 * but not necessarily - e.g. because no buffers were dirtied. We do
8262 * this because a backup performed in recovery uses minRecoveryPoint
8263 * to determine which WAL files must be included in the backup, and
8264 * the file (or files) containing the checkpoint record must be
8265 * included, at a minimum. Note that for an ordinary restart of
8266 * recovery there's no value in having the minimum recovery point any
8267 * earlier than this anyway, because redo will begin just after the
8268 * checkpoint record.
8269 */
8271 {
8272 if (ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint < lastCheckPointEndPtr)
8273 {
8274 ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint = lastCheckPointEndPtr;
8276
8277 /* update local copy */
8280 }
8281 if (flags & CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN)
8283 }
8284
8285 /* we shall start with the latest checksum version */
8287
8289 }
8291
8292 /*
8293 * Update the average distance between checkpoints/restartpoints if the
8294 * prior checkpoint exists.
8295 */
8298
8299 /*
8300 * Delete old log files, those no longer needed for last restartpoint to
8301 * prevent the disk holding the xlog from growing full.
8302 */
8304
8305 /*
8306 * Retreat _logSegNo using the current end of xlog replayed or received,
8307 * whichever is later.
8308 */
8310 replayPtr = GetXLogReplayRecPtr(&replayTLI);
8311 endptr = (receivePtr < replayPtr) ? replayPtr : receivePtr;
8312 KeepLogSeg(endptr, &_logSegNo);
8313
8314 INJECTION_POINT("restartpoint-before-slot-invalidation", NULL);
8315
8319 {
8320 /*
8321 * Some slots have been invalidated; recalculate the old-segment
8322 * horizon, starting again from RedoRecPtr.
8323 */
8325 KeepLogSeg(endptr, &_logSegNo);
8326 }
8327 _logSegNo--;
8328
8329 /*
8330 * Try to recycle segments on a useful timeline. If we've been promoted
8331 * since the beginning of this restartpoint, use the new timeline chosen
8332 * at end of recovery. If we're still in recovery, use the timeline we're
8333 * currently replaying.
8334 *
8335 * There is no guarantee that the WAL segments will be useful on the
8336 * current timeline; if recovery proceeds to a new timeline right after
8337 * this, the pre-allocated WAL segments on this timeline will not be used,
8338 * and will go wasted until recycled on the next restartpoint. We'll live
8339 * with that.
8340 */
8341 if (!RecoveryInProgress())
8342 replayTLI = XLogCtl->InsertTimeLineID;
8343
8344 RemoveOldXlogFiles(_logSegNo, RedoRecPtr, endptr, replayTLI);
8345
8346 /*
8347 * Make more log segments if needed. (Do this after recycling old log
8348 * segments, since that may supply some of the needed files.)
8349 */
8350 PreallocXlogFiles(endptr, replayTLI);
8351
8352 /*
8353 * Truncate pg_subtrans if possible. We can throw away all data before
8354 * the oldest XMIN of any running transaction. No future transaction will
8355 * attempt to reference any pg_subtrans entry older than that (see Asserts
8356 * in subtrans.c). When hot standby is disabled, though, we mustn't do
8357 * this because StartupSUBTRANS hasn't been called yet.
8358 */
8359 if (EnableHotStandby)
8361
8362 /* Real work is done; log and update stats. */
8363 LogCheckpointEnd(true, flags);
8364
8365 /* Reset the process title */
8366 update_checkpoint_display(flags, true, true);
8367
8370 errmsg("recovery restart point at %X/%08X",
8371 LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(lastCheckPoint.redo)),
8372 xtime ? errdetail("Last completed transaction was at log time %s.",
8374
8375 /*
8376 * Finally, execute archive_cleanup_command, if any.
8377 */
8380 "archive_cleanup_command",
8381 false,
8383
8384 return true;
8385}
8386
8387/*
8388 * Report availability of WAL for the given target LSN
8389 * (typically a slot's restart_lsn)
8390 *
8391 * Returns one of the following enum values:
8392 *
8393 * * WALAVAIL_RESERVED means targetLSN is available and it is in the range of
8394 * max_wal_size.
8395 *
8396 * * WALAVAIL_EXTENDED means it is still available by preserving extra
8397 * segments beyond max_wal_size. If max_slot_wal_keep_size is smaller
8398 * than max_wal_size, this state is not returned.
8399 *
8400 * * WALAVAIL_UNRESERVED means it is being lost and the next checkpoint will
8401 * remove reserved segments. The walsender using this slot may return to the
8402 * above.
8403 *
8404 * * WALAVAIL_REMOVED means it has been removed. A replication stream on
8405 * a slot with this LSN cannot continue. (Any associated walsender
8406 * processes should have been terminated already.)
8407 *
8408 * * WALAVAIL_INVALID_LSN means the slot hasn't been set to reserve WAL.
8409 */
8412{
8413 XLogRecPtr currpos; /* current write LSN */
8414 XLogSegNo currSeg; /* segid of currpos */
8415 XLogSegNo targetSeg; /* segid of targetLSN */
8416 XLogSegNo oldestSeg; /* actual oldest segid */
8417 XLogSegNo oldestSegMaxWalSize; /* oldest segid kept by max_wal_size */
8418 XLogSegNo oldestSlotSeg; /* oldest segid kept by slot */
8420
8421 /*
8422 * slot does not reserve WAL. Either deactivated, or has never been active
8423 */
8425 return WALAVAIL_INVALID_LSN;
8426
8427 /*
8428 * Calculate the oldest segment currently reserved by all slots,
8429 * considering wal_keep_size and max_slot_wal_keep_size. Initialize
8430 * oldestSlotSeg to the current segment.
8431 */
8432 currpos = GetXLogWriteRecPtr();
8434 KeepLogSeg(currpos, &oldestSlotSeg);
8435
8436 /*
8437 * Find the oldest extant segment file. We get 1 until checkpoint removes
8438 * the first WAL segment file since startup, which causes the status being
8439 * wrong under certain abnormal conditions but that doesn't actually harm.
8440 */
8442
8443 /* calculate oldest segment by max_wal_size */
8446
8447 if (currSeg > keepSegs)
8449 else
8451
8452 /* the segment we care about */
8454
8455 /*
8456 * No point in returning reserved or extended status values if the
8457 * targetSeg is known to be lost.
8458 */
8459 if (targetSeg >= oldestSlotSeg)
8460 {
8461 /* show "reserved" when targetSeg is within max_wal_size */
8463 return WALAVAIL_RESERVED;
8464
8465 /* being retained by slots exceeding max_wal_size */
8466 return WALAVAIL_EXTENDED;
8467 }
8468
8469 /* WAL segments are no longer retained but haven't been removed yet */
8470 if (targetSeg >= oldestSeg)
8471 return WALAVAIL_UNRESERVED;
8472
8473 /* Definitely lost */
8474 return WALAVAIL_REMOVED;
8475}
8476
8477
8478/*
8479 * Retreat *logSegNo to the last segment that we need to retain because of
8480 * either wal_keep_size or replication slots.
8481 *
8482 * This is calculated by subtracting wal_keep_size from the given xlog
8483 * location, recptr and by making sure that that result is below the
8484 * requirement of replication slots. For the latter criterion we do consider
8485 * the effects of max_slot_wal_keep_size: reserve at most that much space back
8486 * from recptr.
8487 *
8488 * Note about replication slots: if this function calculates a value
8489 * that's further ahead than what slots need reserved, then affected
8490 * slots need to be invalidated and this function invoked again.
8491 * XXX it might be a good idea to rewrite this function so that
8492 * invalidation is optionally done here, instead.
8493 */
8494static void
8496{
8498 XLogSegNo segno;
8500
8502 segno = currSegNo;
8503
8504 /* Calculate how many segments are kept by slots. */
8507 {
8509
8510 /*
8511 * Account for max_slot_wal_keep_size to avoid keeping more than
8512 * configured. However, don't do that during a binary upgrade: if
8513 * slots were to be invalidated because of this, it would not be
8514 * possible to preserve logical ones during the upgrade.
8515 */
8517 {
8519
8522
8523 if (currSegNo - segno > slot_keep_segs)
8524 segno = currSegNo - slot_keep_segs;
8525 }
8526 }
8527
8528 /*
8529 * If WAL summarization is in use, don't remove WAL that has yet to be
8530 * summarized.
8531 */
8534 {
8536
8538 if (unsummarized_segno < segno)
8539 segno = unsummarized_segno;
8540 }
8541
8542 /* but, keep at least wal_keep_size if that's set */
8543 if (wal_keep_size_mb > 0)
8544 {
8546
8548 if (currSegNo - segno < keep_segs)
8549 {
8550 /* avoid underflow, don't go below 1 */
8551 if (currSegNo <= keep_segs)
8552 segno = 1;
8553 else
8554 segno = currSegNo - keep_segs;
8555 }
8556 }
8557
8558 /* don't delete WAL segments newer than the calculated segment */
8559 if (segno < *logSegNo)
8560 *logSegNo = segno;
8561}
8562
8563/*
8564 * Write a NEXTOID log record
8565 */
8566void
8568{
8570 XLogRegisterData(&nextOid, sizeof(Oid));
8572
8573 /*
8574 * We need not flush the NEXTOID record immediately, because any of the
8575 * just-allocated OIDs could only reach disk as part of a tuple insert or
8576 * update that would have its own XLOG record that must follow the NEXTOID
8577 * record. Therefore, the standard buffer LSN interlock applied to those
8578 * records will ensure no such OID reaches disk before the NEXTOID record
8579 * does.
8580 *
8581 * Note, however, that the above statement only covers state "within" the
8582 * database. When we use a generated OID as a file or directory name, we
8583 * are in a sense violating the basic WAL rule, because that filesystem
8584 * change may reach disk before the NEXTOID WAL record does. The impact
8585 * of this is that if a database crash occurs immediately afterward, we
8586 * might after restart re-generate the same OID and find that it conflicts
8587 * with the leftover file or directory. But since for safety's sake we
8588 * always loop until finding a nonconflicting filename, this poses no real
8589 * problem in practice. See pgsql-hackers discussion 27-Sep-2006.
8590 */
8591}
8592
8593/*
8594 * Write an XLOG SWITCH record.
8595 *
8596 * Here we just blindly issue an XLogInsert request for the record.
8597 * All the magic happens inside XLogInsert.
8598 *
8599 * The return value is either the end+1 address of the switch record,
8600 * or the end+1 address of the prior segment if we did not need to
8601 * write a switch record because we are already at segment start.
8602 */
8605{
8607
8608 /* XLOG SWITCH has no data */
8610
8611 if (mark_unimportant)
8614
8615 return RecPtr;
8616}
8617
8618/*
8619 * Write a RESTORE POINT record
8620 */
8623{
8626
8628 strlcpy(xlrec.rp_name, rpName, MAXFNAMELEN);
8629
8632
8634
8635 ereport(LOG,
8636 errmsg("restore point \"%s\" created at %X/%08X",
8638
8639 return RecPtr;
8640}
8641
8642/*
8643 * Write an empty XLOG record to assign a distinct LSN.
8644 *
8645 * This is used by some index AMs when building indexes on permanent relations
8646 * with wal_level=minimal. In that scenario, WAL-logging will start after
8647 * commit, but the index AM needs distinct LSNs to detect concurrent page
8648 * modifications. When the current WAL insert position hasn't advanced since
8649 * the last call, we emit a dummy record to ensure we get a new, distinct LSN.
8650 */
8653{
8654 int dummy = 0;
8655
8656 /*
8657 * Records other than XLOG_SWITCH must have content. We use an integer 0
8658 * to satisfy this restriction.
8659 */
8662 XLogRegisterData(&dummy, sizeof(dummy));
8664}
8665
8666/*
8667 * Check if any of the GUC parameters that are critical for hot standby
8668 * have changed, and update the value in pg_control file if necessary.
8669 */
8670static void
8672{
8681 {
8682 /*
8683 * The change in number of backend slots doesn't need to be WAL-logged
8684 * if archiving is not enabled, as you can't start archive recovery
8685 * with wal_level=minimal anyway. We don't really care about the
8686 * values in pg_control either if wal_level=minimal, but seems better
8687 * to keep them up-to-date to avoid confusion.
8688 */
8690 {
8693
8695 xlrec.max_worker_processes = max_worker_processes;
8696 xlrec.max_wal_senders = max_wal_senders;
8697 xlrec.max_prepared_xacts = max_prepared_xacts;
8698 xlrec.max_locks_per_xact = max_locks_per_xact;
8699 xlrec.wal_level = wal_level;
8700 xlrec.wal_log_hints = wal_log_hints;
8701 xlrec.track_commit_timestamp = track_commit_timestamp;
8702
8704 XLogRegisterData(&xlrec, sizeof(xlrec));
8705
8708 }
8709
8711
8721
8723 }
8724}
8725
8726/*
8727 * Log the new state of checksums
8728 */
8729static void
8743
8744/*
8745 * Update full_page_writes in shared memory, and write an
8746 * XLOG_FPW_CHANGE record if necessary.
8747 *
8748 * Note: this function assumes there is no other process running
8749 * concurrently that could update it.
8750 */
8751void
8753{
8755 bool recoveryInProgress;
8756
8757 /*
8758 * Do nothing if full_page_writes has not been changed.
8759 *
8760 * It's safe to check the shared full_page_writes without the lock,
8761 * because we assume that there is no concurrently running process which
8762 * can update it.
8763 */
8764 if (fullPageWrites == Insert->fullPageWrites)
8765 return;
8766
8767 /*
8768 * Perform this outside critical section so that the WAL insert
8769 * initialization done by RecoveryInProgress() doesn't trigger an
8770 * assertion failure.
8771 */
8773
8775
8776 /*
8777 * It's always safe to take full page images, even when not strictly
8778 * required, but not the other round. So if we're setting full_page_writes
8779 * to true, first set it true and then write the WAL record. If we're
8780 * setting it to false, first write the WAL record and then set the global
8781 * flag.
8782 */
8783 if (fullPageWrites)
8784 {
8786 Insert->fullPageWrites = true;
8788 }
8789
8790 /*
8791 * Write an XLOG_FPW_CHANGE record. This allows us to keep track of
8792 * full_page_writes during archive recovery, if required.
8793 */
8795 {
8797 XLogRegisterData(&fullPageWrites, sizeof(bool));
8798
8800 }
8801
8802 if (!fullPageWrites)
8803 {
8805 Insert->fullPageWrites = false;
8807 }
8809}
8810
8811/*
8812 * XLOG resource manager's routines
8813 *
8814 * Definitions of info values are in include/catalog/pg_control.h, though
8815 * not all record types are related to control file updates.
8816 *
8817 * NOTE: Some XLOG record types that are directly related to WAL recovery
8818 * are handled in xlogrecovery_redo().
8819 */
8820void
8822{
8823 uint8 info = XLogRecGetInfo(record) & ~XLR_INFO_MASK;
8824 XLogRecPtr lsn = record->EndRecPtr;
8825
8826 /*
8827 * In XLOG rmgr, backup blocks are only used by XLOG_FPI and
8828 * XLOG_FPI_FOR_HINT records.
8829 */
8830 Assert(info == XLOG_FPI || info == XLOG_FPI_FOR_HINT ||
8831 !XLogRecHasAnyBlockRefs(record));
8832
8833 if (info == XLOG_NEXTOID)
8834 {
8835 Oid nextOid;
8836
8837 /*
8838 * We used to try to take the maximum of TransamVariables->nextOid and
8839 * the recorded nextOid, but that fails if the OID counter wraps
8840 * around. Since no OID allocation should be happening during replay
8841 * anyway, better to just believe the record exactly. We still take
8842 * OidGenLock while setting the variable, just in case.
8843 */
8844 memcpy(&nextOid, XLogRecGetData(record), sizeof(Oid));
8846 TransamVariables->nextOid = nextOid;
8849 }
8850 else if (info == XLOG_CHECKPOINT_SHUTDOWN)
8851 {
8852 CheckPoint checkPoint;
8853 TimeLineID replayTLI;
8854
8855 memcpy(&checkPoint, XLogRecGetData(record), sizeof(CheckPoint));
8856 /* In a SHUTDOWN checkpoint, believe the counters exactly */
8858 TransamVariables->nextXid = checkPoint.nextXid;
8861 TransamVariables->nextOid = checkPoint.nextOid;
8865 checkPoint.nextMultiOffset);
8866
8868 checkPoint.oldestMultiDB);
8869
8870 /*
8871 * No need to set oldestClogXid here as well; it'll be set when we
8872 * redo an xl_clog_truncate if it changed since initialization.
8873 */
8874 SetTransactionIdLimit(checkPoint.oldestXid, checkPoint.oldestXidDB);
8875
8876 /*
8877 * If we see a shutdown checkpoint while waiting for an end-of-backup
8878 * record, the backup was canceled and the end-of-backup record will
8879 * never arrive.
8880 */
8884 ereport(PANIC,
8885 (errmsg("online backup was canceled, recovery cannot continue")));
8886
8887 /*
8888 * If we see a shutdown checkpoint, we know that nothing was running
8889 * on the primary at this point. So fake-up an empty running-xacts
8890 * record and use that here and now. Recover additional standby state
8891 * for prepared transactions.
8892 */
8894 {
8895 TransactionId *xids;
8896 int nxids;
8898 TransactionId latestCompletedXid;
8900
8902
8903 /* Update pg_subtrans entries for any prepared transactions */
8905
8906 /*
8907 * Construct a RunningTransactions snapshot representing a shut
8908 * down server, with only prepared transactions still alive. We're
8909 * never overflowed at this point because all subxids are listed
8910 * with their parent prepared transactions.
8911 */
8912 running.xcnt = nxids;
8913 running.subxcnt = 0;
8915 running.nextXid = XidFromFullTransactionId(checkPoint.nextXid);
8917 latestCompletedXid = XidFromFullTransactionId(checkPoint.nextXid);
8918 TransactionIdRetreat(latestCompletedXid);
8919 Assert(TransactionIdIsNormal(latestCompletedXid));
8920 running.latestCompletedXid = latestCompletedXid;
8921 running.xids = xids;
8922
8924 }
8925
8926 /* ControlFile->checkPointCopy always tracks the latest ckpt XID */
8930
8933
8934 /*
8935 * We should've already switched to the new TLI before replaying this
8936 * record.
8937 */
8938 (void) GetCurrentReplayRecPtr(&replayTLI);
8939 if (checkPoint.ThisTimeLineID != replayTLI)
8940 ereport(PANIC,
8941 (errmsg("unexpected timeline ID %u (should be %u) in shutdown checkpoint record",
8942 checkPoint.ThisTimeLineID, replayTLI)));
8943
8944 RecoveryRestartPoint(&checkPoint, record);
8945
8946 /*
8947 * After replaying a checkpoint record, free all smgr objects.
8948 * Otherwise we would never do so for dropped relations, as the
8949 * startup does not process shared invalidation messages or call
8950 * AtEOXact_SMgr().
8951 */
8953 }
8954 else if (info == XLOG_CHECKPOINT_ONLINE)
8955 {
8956 CheckPoint checkPoint;
8957 TimeLineID replayTLI;
8958
8959 memcpy(&checkPoint, XLogRecGetData(record), sizeof(CheckPoint));
8960 /* In an ONLINE checkpoint, treat the XID counter as a minimum */
8963 checkPoint.nextXid))
8964 TransamVariables->nextXid = checkPoint.nextXid;
8966
8967 /*
8968 * We ignore the nextOid counter in an ONLINE checkpoint, preferring
8969 * to track OID assignment through XLOG_NEXTOID records. The nextOid
8970 * counter is from the start of the checkpoint and might well be stale
8971 * compared to later XLOG_NEXTOID records. We could try to take the
8972 * maximum of the nextOid counter and our latest value, but since
8973 * there's no particular guarantee about the speed with which the OID
8974 * counter wraps around, that's a risky thing to do. In any case,
8975 * users of the nextOid counter are required to avoid assignment of
8976 * duplicates, so that a somewhat out-of-date value should be safe.
8977 */
8978
8979 /* Handle multixact */
8981 checkPoint.nextMultiOffset);
8982
8983 /*
8984 * NB: This may perform multixact truncation when replaying WAL
8985 * generated by an older primary.
8986 */
8988 checkPoint.oldestMultiDB);
8990 checkPoint.oldestXid))
8992 checkPoint.oldestXidDB);
8993 /* ControlFile->checkPointCopy always tracks the latest ckpt XID */
8997
8998 /* TLI should not change in an on-line checkpoint */
8999 (void) GetCurrentReplayRecPtr(&replayTLI);
9000 if (checkPoint.ThisTimeLineID != replayTLI)
9001 ereport(PANIC,
9002 (errmsg("unexpected timeline ID %u (should be %u) in online checkpoint record",
9003 checkPoint.ThisTimeLineID, replayTLI)));
9004
9005 RecoveryRestartPoint(&checkPoint, record);
9006
9007 /*
9008 * After replaying a checkpoint record, free all smgr objects.
9009 * Otherwise we would never do so for dropped relations, as the
9010 * startup does not process shared invalidation messages or call
9011 * AtEOXact_SMgr().
9012 */
9014 }
9015 else if (info == XLOG_OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD)
9016 {
9017 /* nothing to do here, handled in xlogrecovery_redo() */
9018 }
9019 else if (info == XLOG_END_OF_RECOVERY)
9020 {
9022 TimeLineID replayTLI;
9023
9024 memcpy(&xlrec, XLogRecGetData(record), sizeof(xl_end_of_recovery));
9025
9026 /*
9027 * For Hot Standby, we could treat this like a Shutdown Checkpoint,
9028 * but this case is rarer and harder to test, so the benefit doesn't
9029 * outweigh the potential extra cost of maintenance.
9030 */
9031
9032 /*
9033 * We should've already switched to the new TLI before replaying this
9034 * record.
9035 */
9036 (void) GetCurrentReplayRecPtr(&replayTLI);
9037 if (xlrec.ThisTimeLineID != replayTLI)
9038 ereport(PANIC,
9039 (errmsg("unexpected timeline ID %u (should be %u) in end-of-recovery record",
9040 xlrec.ThisTimeLineID, replayTLI)));
9041 }
9042 else if (info == XLOG_NOOP)
9043 {
9044 /* nothing to do here */
9045 }
9046 else if (info == XLOG_SWITCH)
9047 {
9048 /* nothing to do here */
9049 }
9050 else if (info == XLOG_RESTORE_POINT)
9051 {
9052 /* nothing to do here, handled in xlogrecovery.c */
9053 }
9054 else if (info == XLOG_ASSIGN_LSN)
9055 {
9056 /* nothing to do here, see XLogGetFakeLSN() */
9057 }
9058 else if (info == XLOG_FPI || info == XLOG_FPI_FOR_HINT)
9059 {
9060 /*
9061 * XLOG_FPI records contain nothing else but one or more block
9062 * references. Every block reference must include a full-page image
9063 * even if full_page_writes was disabled when the record was generated
9064 * - otherwise there would be no point in this record.
9065 *
9066 * XLOG_FPI_FOR_HINT records are generated when a page needs to be
9067 * WAL-logged because of a hint bit update. They are only generated
9068 * when checksums and/or wal_log_hints are enabled. They may include
9069 * no full-page images if full_page_writes was disabled when they were
9070 * generated. In this case there is nothing to do here.
9071 *
9072 * No recovery conflicts are generated by these generic records - if a
9073 * resource manager needs to generate conflicts, it has to define a
9074 * separate WAL record type and redo routine.
9075 */
9076 for (uint8 block_id = 0; block_id <= XLogRecMaxBlockId(record); block_id++)
9077 {
9078 Buffer buffer;
9079
9080 if (!XLogRecHasBlockImage(record, block_id))
9081 {
9082 if (info == XLOG_FPI)
9083 elog(ERROR, "XLOG_FPI record did not contain a full-page image");
9084 continue;
9085 }
9086
9087 if (XLogReadBufferForRedo(record, block_id, &buffer) != BLK_RESTORED)
9088 elog(ERROR, "unexpected XLogReadBufferForRedo result when restoring backup block");
9089 UnlockReleaseBuffer(buffer);
9090 }
9091 }
9092 else if (info == XLOG_BACKUP_END)
9093 {
9094 /* nothing to do here, handled in xlogrecovery_redo() */
9095 }
9096 else if (info == XLOG_PARAMETER_CHANGE)
9097 {
9099
9100 /* Update our copy of the parameters in pg_control */
9101 memcpy(&xlrec, XLogRecGetData(record), sizeof(xl_parameter_change));
9102
9104 ControlFile->MaxConnections = xlrec.MaxConnections;
9105 ControlFile->max_worker_processes = xlrec.max_worker_processes;
9106 ControlFile->max_wal_senders = xlrec.max_wal_senders;
9107 ControlFile->max_prepared_xacts = xlrec.max_prepared_xacts;
9108 ControlFile->max_locks_per_xact = xlrec.max_locks_per_xact;
9109 ControlFile->wal_level = xlrec.wal_level;
9110 ControlFile->wal_log_hints = xlrec.wal_log_hints;
9111
9112 /*
9113 * Update minRecoveryPoint to ensure that if recovery is aborted, we
9114 * recover back up to this point before allowing hot standby again.
9115 * This is important if the max_* settings are decreased, to ensure
9116 * you don't run queries against the WAL preceding the change. The
9117 * local copies cannot be updated as long as crash recovery is
9118 * happening and we expect all the WAL to be replayed.
9119 */
9121 {
9124 }
9126 {
9127 TimeLineID replayTLI;
9128
9129 (void) GetCurrentReplayRecPtr(&replayTLI);
9131 ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI = replayTLI;
9132 }
9133
9134 CommitTsParameterChange(xlrec.track_commit_timestamp,
9136 ControlFile->track_commit_timestamp = xlrec.track_commit_timestamp;
9137
9140
9141 /* Check to see if any parameter change gives a problem on recovery */
9143 }
9144 else if (info == XLOG_FPW_CHANGE)
9145 {
9146 bool fpw;
9147
9148 memcpy(&fpw, XLogRecGetData(record), sizeof(bool));
9149
9150 /*
9151 * Update the LSN of the last replayed XLOG_FPW_CHANGE record so that
9152 * do_pg_backup_start() and do_pg_backup_stop() can check whether
9153 * full_page_writes has been disabled during online backup.
9154 */
9155 if (!fpw)
9156 {
9161 }
9162
9163 /* Keep track of full_page_writes */
9165 }
9166 else if (info == XLOG_CHECKPOINT_REDO)
9167 {
9169 bool new_state = false;
9170
9172
9174 XLogCtl->data_checksum_version = redo_rec.data_checksum_version;
9175 SetLocalDataChecksumState(redo_rec.data_checksum_version);
9176 if (redo_rec.data_checksum_version != ControlFile->data_checksum_version)
9177 new_state = true;
9179
9180 if (new_state)
9181 EmitAndWaitDataChecksumsBarrier(redo_rec.data_checksum_version);
9182 }
9183 else if (info == XLOG_LOGICAL_DECODING_STATUS_CHANGE)
9184 {
9185 bool status;
9186
9187 memcpy(&status, XLogRecGetData(record), sizeof(bool));
9188
9189 /*
9190 * We need to toggle the logical decoding status and update the
9191 * XLogLogicalInfo cache of processes synchronously because
9192 * XLogLogicalInfoActive() is used even during read-only queries
9193 * (e.g., via RelationIsAccessibleInLogicalDecoding()). In the
9194 * 'disable' case, it is safe to invalidate existing slots after
9195 * disabling logical decoding because logical decoding cannot process
9196 * subsequent WAL records, which may not contain logical information.
9197 */
9198 if (status)
9200 else
9202
9203 elog(DEBUG1, "update logical decoding status to %d during recovery",
9204 status);
9205
9206 if (InRecovery && InHotStandby)
9207 {
9208 if (!status)
9209 {
9210 /*
9211 * Invalidate logical slots if we are in hot standby and the
9212 * primary disabled logical decoding.
9213 */
9215 0, InvalidOid,
9217 }
9218 else if (sync_replication_slots)
9219 {
9220 /*
9221 * Signal the postmaster to launch the slotsync worker.
9222 *
9223 * XXX: For simplicity, we keep the slotsync worker running
9224 * even after logical decoding is disabled. A future
9225 * improvement can consider starting and stopping the worker
9226 * based on logical decoding status change.
9227 */
9229 }
9230 }
9231 }
9232}
9233
9234void
9236{
9237 uint8 info = XLogRecGetInfo(record) & ~XLR_INFO_MASK;
9238
9239 if (info == XLOG2_CHECKSUMS)
9240 {
9242
9243 memcpy(&state, XLogRecGetData(record), sizeof(xl_checksum_state));
9244
9246 XLogCtl->data_checksum_version = state.new_checksum_state;
9248
9250 ControlFile->data_checksum_version = state.new_checksum_state;
9253
9254 /*
9255 * Block on a procsignalbarrier to await all processes having seen the
9256 * change to checksum status. Once the barrier has been passed we can
9257 * initiate the corresponding processing.
9258 */
9259 EmitAndWaitDataChecksumsBarrier(state.new_checksum_state);
9260 }
9261}
9262
9263/*
9264 * Return the extra open flags used for opening a file, depending on the
9265 * value of the GUCs wal_sync_method, fsync and debug_io_direct.
9266 */
9267static int
9268get_sync_bit(int method)
9269{
9270 int o_direct_flag = 0;
9271
9272 /*
9273 * Use O_DIRECT if requested, except in walreceiver process. The WAL
9274 * written by walreceiver is normally read by the startup process soon
9275 * after it's written. Also, walreceiver performs unaligned writes, which
9276 * don't work with O_DIRECT, so it is required for correctness too.
9277 */
9280
9281 /* If fsync is disabled, never open in sync mode */
9282 if (!enableFsync)
9283 return o_direct_flag;
9284
9285 switch (method)
9286 {
9287 /*
9288 * enum values for all sync options are defined even if they are
9289 * not supported on the current platform. But if not, they are
9290 * not included in the enum option array, and therefore will never
9291 * be seen here.
9292 */
9296 return o_direct_flag;
9297#ifdef O_SYNC
9299 return O_SYNC | o_direct_flag;
9300#endif
9301#ifdef O_DSYNC
9303 return O_DSYNC | o_direct_flag;
9304#endif
9305 default:
9306 /* can't happen (unless we are out of sync with option array) */
9307 elog(ERROR, "unrecognized \"wal_sync_method\": %d", method);
9308 return 0; /* silence warning */
9309 }
9310}
9311
9312/*
9313 * GUC support
9314 */
9315void
9317{
9319 {
9320 /*
9321 * To ensure that no blocks escape unsynced, force an fsync on the
9322 * currently open log segment (if any). Also, if the open flag is
9323 * changing, close the log file so it will be reopened (with new flag
9324 * bit) at next use.
9325 */
9326 if (openLogFile >= 0)
9327 {
9329 if (pg_fsync(openLogFile) != 0)
9330 {
9331 char xlogfname[MAXFNAMELEN];
9332 int save_errno;
9333
9334 save_errno = errno;
9337 errno = save_errno;
9338 ereport(PANIC,
9340 errmsg("could not fsync file \"%s\": %m", xlogfname)));
9341 }
9342
9345 XLogFileClose();
9346 }
9347 }
9348}
9349
9350
9351/*
9352 * Issue appropriate kind of fsync (if any) for an XLOG output file.
9353 *
9354 * 'fd' is a file descriptor for the XLOG file to be fsync'd.
9355 * 'segno' is for error reporting purposes.
9356 */
9357void
9359{
9360 char *msg = NULL;
9362
9363 Assert(tli != 0);
9364
9365 /*
9366 * Quick exit if fsync is disabled or write() has already synced the WAL
9367 * file.
9368 */
9369 if (!enableFsync ||
9372 return;
9373
9374 /*
9375 * Measure I/O timing to sync the WAL file for pg_stat_io.
9376 */
9378
9380 switch (wal_sync_method)
9381 {
9383 if (pg_fsync_no_writethrough(fd) != 0)
9384 msg = _("could not fsync file \"%s\": %m");
9385 break;
9386#ifdef HAVE_FSYNC_WRITETHROUGH
9388 if (pg_fsync_writethrough(fd) != 0)
9389 msg = _("could not fsync write-through file \"%s\": %m");
9390 break;
9391#endif
9393 if (pg_fdatasync(fd) != 0)
9394 msg = _("could not fdatasync file \"%s\": %m");
9395 break;
9398 /* not reachable */
9399 Assert(false);
9400 break;
9401 default:
9402 ereport(PANIC,
9404 errmsg_internal("unrecognized \"wal_sync_method\": %d", wal_sync_method));
9405 break;
9406 }
9407
9408 /* PANIC if failed to fsync */
9409 if (msg)
9410 {
9411 char xlogfname[MAXFNAMELEN];
9412 int save_errno = errno;
9413
9415 errno = save_errno;
9416 ereport(PANIC,
9418 errmsg(msg, xlogfname)));
9419 }
9420
9422
9424 start, 1, 0);
9425}
9426
9427/*
9428 * do_pg_backup_start is the workhorse of the user-visible pg_backup_start()
9429 * function. It creates the necessary starting checkpoint and constructs the
9430 * backup state and tablespace map.
9431 *
9432 * Input parameters are "state" (the backup state), "fast" (if true, we do
9433 * the checkpoint in fast mode), and "tablespaces" (if non-NULL, indicates a
9434 * list of tablespaceinfo structs describing the cluster's tablespaces.).
9435 *
9436 * The tablespace map contents are appended to passed-in parameter
9437 * tablespace_map and the caller is responsible for including it in the backup
9438 * archive as 'tablespace_map'. The tablespace_map file is required mainly for
9439 * tar format in windows as native windows utilities are not able to create
9440 * symlinks while extracting files from tar. However for consistency and
9441 * platform-independence, we do it the same way everywhere.
9442 *
9443 * It fills in "state" with the information required for the backup, such
9444 * as the minimum WAL location that must be present to restore from this
9445 * backup (starttli) and the corresponding timeline ID (starttli).
9446 *
9447 * Every successfully started backup must be stopped by calling
9448 * do_pg_backup_stop() or do_pg_abort_backup(). There can be many
9449 * backups active at the same time.
9450 *
9451 * It is the responsibility of the caller of this function to verify the
9452 * permissions of the calling user!
9453 */
9454void
9455do_pg_backup_start(const char *backupidstr, bool fast, List **tablespaces,
9457{
9459
9460 Assert(state != NULL);
9462
9463 /*
9464 * During recovery, we don't need to check WAL level. Because, if WAL
9465 * level is not sufficient, it's impossible to get here during recovery.
9466 */
9468 ereport(ERROR,
9470 errmsg("WAL level not sufficient for making an online backup"),
9471 errhint("\"wal_level\" must be set to \"replica\" or \"logical\" at server start.")));
9472
9474 ereport(ERROR,
9476 errmsg("backup label too long (max %d bytes)",
9477 MAXPGPATH)));
9478
9479 strlcpy(state->name, backupidstr, sizeof(state->name));
9480
9481 /*
9482 * Mark backup active in shared memory. We must do full-page WAL writes
9483 * during an on-line backup even if not doing so at other times, because
9484 * it's quite possible for the backup dump to obtain a "torn" (partially
9485 * written) copy of a database page if it reads the page concurrently with
9486 * our write to the same page. This can be fixed as long as the first
9487 * write to the page in the WAL sequence is a full-page write. Hence, we
9488 * increment runningBackups then force a CHECKPOINT, to ensure there are
9489 * no dirty pages in shared memory that might get dumped while the backup
9490 * is in progress without having a corresponding WAL record. (Once the
9491 * backup is complete, we need not force full-page writes anymore, since
9492 * we expect that any pages not modified during the backup interval must
9493 * have been correctly captured by the backup.)
9494 *
9495 * Note that forcing full-page writes has no effect during an online
9496 * backup from the standby.
9497 *
9498 * We must hold all the insertion locks to change the value of
9499 * runningBackups, to ensure adequate interlocking against
9500 * XLogInsertRecord().
9501 */
9505
9506 /*
9507 * Ensure we decrement runningBackups if we fail below. NB -- for this to
9508 * work correctly, it is critical that sessionBackupState is only updated
9509 * after this block is over.
9510 */
9512 {
9513 bool gotUniqueStartpoint = false;
9514 DIR *tblspcdir;
9515 struct dirent *de;
9517 int datadirpathlen;
9518
9519 /*
9520 * Force an XLOG file switch before the checkpoint, to ensure that the
9521 * WAL segment the checkpoint is written to doesn't contain pages with
9522 * old timeline IDs. That would otherwise happen if you called
9523 * pg_backup_start() right after restoring from a PITR archive: the
9524 * first WAL segment containing the startup checkpoint has pages in
9525 * the beginning with the old timeline ID. That can cause trouble at
9526 * recovery: we won't have a history file covering the old timeline if
9527 * pg_wal directory was not included in the base backup and the WAL
9528 * archive was cleared too before starting the backup.
9529 *
9530 * During recovery, we skip forcing XLOG file switch, which means that
9531 * the backup taken during recovery is not available for the special
9532 * recovery case described above.
9533 */
9535 RequestXLogSwitch(false);
9536
9537 do
9538 {
9539 bool checkpointfpw;
9540
9541 /*
9542 * Force a CHECKPOINT. Aside from being necessary to prevent torn
9543 * page problems, this guarantees that two successive backup runs
9544 * will have different checkpoint positions and hence different
9545 * history file names, even if nothing happened in between.
9546 *
9547 * During recovery, establish a restartpoint if possible. We use
9548 * the last restartpoint as the backup starting checkpoint. This
9549 * means that two successive backup runs can have same checkpoint
9550 * positions.
9551 *
9552 * Since the fact that we are executing do_pg_backup_start()
9553 * during recovery means that checkpointer is running, we can use
9554 * RequestCheckpoint() to establish a restartpoint.
9555 *
9556 * We use CHECKPOINT_FAST only if requested by user (via passing
9557 * fast = true). Otherwise this can take awhile.
9558 */
9560 (fast ? CHECKPOINT_FAST : 0));
9561
9562 /*
9563 * Now we need to fetch the checkpoint record location, and also
9564 * its REDO pointer. The oldest point in WAL that would be needed
9565 * to restore starting from the checkpoint is precisely the REDO
9566 * pointer.
9567 */
9569 state->checkpointloc = ControlFile->checkPoint;
9570 state->startpoint = ControlFile->checkPointCopy.redo;
9574
9576 {
9578
9579 /*
9580 * Check to see if all WAL replayed during online backup
9581 * (i.e., since last restartpoint used as backup starting
9582 * checkpoint) contain full-page writes.
9583 */
9587
9588 if (!checkpointfpw || state->startpoint <= recptr)
9589 ereport(ERROR,
9591 errmsg("WAL generated with \"full_page_writes=off\" was replayed "
9592 "since last restartpoint"),
9593 errhint("This means that the backup being taken on the standby "
9594 "is corrupt and should not be used. "
9595 "Enable \"full_page_writes\" and run CHECKPOINT on the primary, "
9596 "and then try an online backup again.")));
9597
9598 /*
9599 * During recovery, since we don't use the end-of-backup WAL
9600 * record and don't write the backup history file, the
9601 * starting WAL location doesn't need to be unique. This means
9602 * that two base backups started at the same time might use
9603 * the same checkpoint as starting locations.
9604 */
9605 gotUniqueStartpoint = true;
9606 }
9607
9608 /*
9609 * If two base backups are started at the same time (in WAL sender
9610 * processes), we need to make sure that they use different
9611 * checkpoints as starting locations, because we use the starting
9612 * WAL location as a unique identifier for the base backup in the
9613 * end-of-backup WAL record and when we write the backup history
9614 * file. Perhaps it would be better generate a separate unique ID
9615 * for each backup instead of forcing another checkpoint, but
9616 * taking a checkpoint right after another is not that expensive
9617 * either because only few buffers have been dirtied yet.
9618 */
9620 if (XLogCtl->Insert.lastBackupStart < state->startpoint)
9621 {
9622 XLogCtl->Insert.lastBackupStart = state->startpoint;
9623 gotUniqueStartpoint = true;
9624 }
9626 } while (!gotUniqueStartpoint);
9627
9628 /*
9629 * Construct tablespace_map file.
9630 */
9632
9633 /* Collect information about all tablespaces */
9635 while ((de = ReadDir(tblspcdir, PG_TBLSPC_DIR)) != NULL)
9636 {
9637 char fullpath[MAXPGPATH + sizeof(PG_TBLSPC_DIR)];
9638 char linkpath[MAXPGPATH];
9639 char *relpath = NULL;
9640 char *s;
9642 char *badp;
9643 Oid tsoid;
9644
9645 /*
9646 * Try to parse the directory name as an unsigned integer.
9647 *
9648 * Tablespace directories should be positive integers that can be
9649 * represented in 32 bits, with no leading zeroes or trailing
9650 * garbage. If we come across a name that doesn't meet those
9651 * criteria, skip it.
9652 */
9653 if (de->d_name[0] < '1' || de->d_name[1] > '9')
9654 continue;
9655 errno = 0;
9656 tsoid = strtoul(de->d_name, &badp, 10);
9657 if (*badp != '\0' || errno == EINVAL || errno == ERANGE)
9658 continue;
9659
9660 snprintf(fullpath, sizeof(fullpath), "%s/%s", PG_TBLSPC_DIR, de->d_name);
9661
9662 de_type = get_dirent_type(fullpath, de, false, ERROR);
9663
9664 if (de_type == PGFILETYPE_LNK)
9665 {
9667 int rllen;
9668
9669 rllen = readlink(fullpath, linkpath, sizeof(linkpath));
9670 if (rllen < 0)
9671 {
9673 (errmsg("could not read symbolic link \"%s\": %m",
9674 fullpath)));
9675 continue;
9676 }
9677 else if (rllen >= sizeof(linkpath))
9678 {
9680 (errmsg("symbolic link \"%s\" target is too long",
9681 fullpath)));
9682 continue;
9683 }
9684 linkpath[rllen] = '\0';
9685
9686 /*
9687 * Relpath holds the relative path of the tablespace directory
9688 * when it's located within PGDATA, or NULL if it's located
9689 * elsewhere.
9690 */
9691 if (rllen > datadirpathlen &&
9695
9696 /*
9697 * Add a backslash-escaped version of the link path to the
9698 * tablespace map file.
9699 */
9701 for (s = linkpath; *s; s++)
9702 {
9703 if (*s == '\n' || *s == '\r' || *s == '\\')
9706 }
9708 de->d_name, escapedpath.data);
9709 pfree(escapedpath.data);
9710 }
9711 else if (de_type == PGFILETYPE_DIR)
9712 {
9713 /*
9714 * It's possible to use allow_in_place_tablespaces to create
9715 * directories directly under pg_tblspc, for testing purposes
9716 * only.
9717 *
9718 * In this case, we store a relative path rather than an
9719 * absolute path into the tablespaceinfo.
9720 */
9721 snprintf(linkpath, sizeof(linkpath), "%s/%s",
9722 PG_TBLSPC_DIR, de->d_name);
9724 }
9725 else
9726 {
9727 /* Skip any other file type that appears here. */
9728 continue;
9729 }
9730
9732 ti->oid = tsoid;
9733 ti->path = pstrdup(linkpath);
9734 ti->rpath = relpath;
9735 ti->size = -1;
9736
9737 if (tablespaces)
9738 *tablespaces = lappend(*tablespaces, ti);
9739 }
9741
9742 state->starttime = (pg_time_t) time(NULL);
9743 }
9745
9746 state->started_in_recovery = backup_started_in_recovery;
9747
9748 /*
9749 * Mark that the start phase has correctly finished for the backup.
9750 */
9752}
9753
9754/*
9755 * Utility routine to fetch the session-level status of a backup running.
9756 */
9759{
9760 return sessionBackupState;
9761}
9762
9763/*
9764 * do_pg_backup_stop
9765 *
9766 * Utility function called at the end of an online backup. It creates history
9767 * file (if required), resets sessionBackupState and so on. It can optionally
9768 * wait for WAL segments to be archived.
9769 *
9770 * "state" is filled with the information necessary to restore from this
9771 * backup with its stop LSN (stoppoint), its timeline ID (stoptli), etc.
9772 *
9773 * It is the responsibility of the caller of this function to verify the
9774 * permissions of the calling user!
9775 */
9776void
9778{
9779 bool backup_stopped_in_recovery = false;
9780 char histfilepath[MAXPGPATH];
9784 FILE *fp;
9786 int waits = 0;
9787 bool reported_waiting = false;
9788
9789 Assert(state != NULL);
9790
9792
9793 /*
9794 * During recovery, we don't need to check WAL level. Because, if WAL
9795 * level is not sufficient, it's impossible to get here during recovery.
9796 */
9798 ereport(ERROR,
9800 errmsg("WAL level not sufficient for making an online backup"),
9801 errhint("\"wal_level\" must be set to \"replica\" or \"logical\" at server start.")));
9802
9803 /*
9804 * OK to update backup counter and session-level lock.
9805 *
9806 * Note that CHECK_FOR_INTERRUPTS() must not occur while updating them,
9807 * otherwise they can be updated inconsistently, which might cause
9808 * do_pg_abort_backup() to fail.
9809 */
9811
9812 /*
9813 * It is expected that each do_pg_backup_start() call is matched by
9814 * exactly one do_pg_backup_stop() call.
9815 */
9818
9819 /*
9820 * Clean up session-level lock.
9821 *
9822 * You might think that WALInsertLockRelease() can be called before
9823 * cleaning up session-level lock because session-level lock doesn't need
9824 * to be protected with WAL insertion lock. But since
9825 * CHECK_FOR_INTERRUPTS() can occur in it, session-level lock must be
9826 * cleaned up before it.
9827 */
9829
9831
9832 /*
9833 * If we are taking an online backup from the standby, we confirm that the
9834 * standby has not been promoted during the backup.
9835 */
9836 if (state->started_in_recovery && !backup_stopped_in_recovery)
9837 ereport(ERROR,
9839 errmsg("the standby was promoted during online backup"),
9840 errhint("This means that the backup being taken is corrupt "
9841 "and should not be used. "
9842 "Try taking another online backup.")));
9843
9844 /*
9845 * During recovery, we don't write an end-of-backup record. We assume that
9846 * pg_control was backed up last and its minimum recovery point can be
9847 * available as the backup end location. Since we don't have an
9848 * end-of-backup record, we use the pg_control value to check whether
9849 * we've reached the end of backup when starting recovery from this
9850 * backup. We have no way of checking if pg_control wasn't backed up last
9851 * however.
9852 *
9853 * We don't force a switch to new WAL file but it is still possible to
9854 * wait for all the required files to be archived if waitforarchive is
9855 * true. This is okay if we use the backup to start a standby and fetch
9856 * the missing WAL using streaming replication. But in the case of an
9857 * archive recovery, a user should set waitforarchive to true and wait for
9858 * them to be archived to ensure that all the required files are
9859 * available.
9860 *
9861 * We return the current minimum recovery point as the backup end
9862 * location. Note that it can be greater than the exact backup end
9863 * location if the minimum recovery point is updated after the backup of
9864 * pg_control. This is harmless for current uses.
9865 *
9866 * XXX currently a backup history file is for informational and debug
9867 * purposes only. It's not essential for an online backup. Furthermore,
9868 * even if it's created, it will not be archived during recovery because
9869 * an archiver is not invoked. So it doesn't seem worthwhile to write a
9870 * backup history file during recovery.
9871 */
9873 {
9875
9876 /*
9877 * Check to see if all WAL replayed during online backup contain
9878 * full-page writes.
9879 */
9883
9884 if (state->startpoint <= recptr)
9885 ereport(ERROR,
9887 errmsg("WAL generated with \"full_page_writes=off\" was replayed "
9888 "during online backup"),
9889 errhint("This means that the backup being taken on the standby "
9890 "is corrupt and should not be used. "
9891 "Enable \"full_page_writes\" and run CHECKPOINT on the primary, "
9892 "and then try an online backup again.")));
9893
9894
9896 state->stoppoint = ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint;
9899 }
9900 else
9901 {
9902 char *history_file;
9903
9904 /*
9905 * Write the backup-end xlog record
9906 */
9908 XLogRegisterData(&state->startpoint,
9909 sizeof(state->startpoint));
9911
9912 /*
9913 * Given that we're not in recovery, InsertTimeLineID is set and can't
9914 * change, so we can read it without a lock.
9915 */
9916 state->stoptli = XLogCtl->InsertTimeLineID;
9917
9918 /*
9919 * Force a switch to a new xlog segment file, so that the backup is
9920 * valid as soon as archiver moves out the current segment file.
9921 */
9922 RequestXLogSwitch(false);
9923
9924 state->stoptime = (pg_time_t) time(NULL);
9925
9926 /*
9927 * Write the backup history file
9928 */
9931 state->startpoint, wal_segment_size);
9932 fp = AllocateFile(histfilepath, "w");
9933 if (!fp)
9934 ereport(ERROR,
9936 errmsg("could not create file \"%s\": %m",
9937 histfilepath)));
9938
9939 /* Build and save the contents of the backup history file */
9941 fprintf(fp, "%s", history_file);
9943
9944 if (fflush(fp) || ferror(fp) || FreeFile(fp))
9945 ereport(ERROR,
9947 errmsg("could not write file \"%s\": %m",
9948 histfilepath)));
9949
9950 /*
9951 * Clean out any no-longer-needed history files. As a side effect,
9952 * this will post a .ready file for the newly created history file,
9953 * notifying the archiver that history file may be archived
9954 * immediately.
9955 */
9957 }
9958
9959 /*
9960 * If archiving is enabled, wait for all the required WAL files to be
9961 * archived before returning. If archiving isn't enabled, the required WAL
9962 * needs to be transported via streaming replication (hopefully with
9963 * wal_keep_size set high enough), or some more exotic mechanism like
9964 * polling and copying files from pg_wal with script. We have no knowledge
9965 * of those mechanisms, so it's up to the user to ensure that he gets all
9966 * the required WAL.
9967 *
9968 * We wait until both the last WAL file filled during backup and the
9969 * history file have been archived, and assume that the alphabetic sorting
9970 * property of the WAL files ensures any earlier WAL files are safely
9971 * archived as well.
9972 *
9973 * We wait forever, since archive_command is supposed to work and we
9974 * assume the admin wanted his backup to work completely. If you don't
9975 * wish to wait, then either waitforarchive should be passed in as false,
9976 * or you can set statement_timeout. Also, some notices are issued to
9977 * clue in anyone who might be doing this interactively.
9978 */
9979
9980 if (waitforarchive &&
9983 {
9987
9990 state->startpoint, wal_segment_size);
9991
9993 waits = 0;
9994
9997 {
9999
10000 if (!reported_waiting && waits > 5)
10001 {
10003 (errmsg("base backup done, waiting for required WAL segments to be archived")));
10004 reported_waiting = true;
10005 }
10006
10009 1000L,
10012
10013 if (++waits >= seconds_before_warning)
10014 {
10015 seconds_before_warning *= 2; /* This wraps in >10 years... */
10017 (errmsg("still waiting for all required WAL segments to be archived (%d seconds elapsed)",
10018 waits),
10019 errhint("Check that your \"archive_command\" is executing properly. "
10020 "You can safely cancel this backup, "
10021 "but the database backup will not be usable without all the WAL segments.")));
10022 }
10023 }
10024
10026 (errmsg("all required WAL segments have been archived")));
10027 }
10028 else if (waitforarchive)
10030 (errmsg("WAL archiving is not enabled; you must ensure that all required WAL segments are copied through other means to complete the backup")));
10031}
10032
10033
10034/*
10035 * do_pg_abort_backup: abort a running backup
10036 *
10037 * This does just the most basic steps of do_pg_backup_stop(), by taking the
10038 * system out of backup mode, thus making it a lot more safe to call from
10039 * an error handler.
10040 *
10041 * 'arg' indicates that it's being called during backup setup; so
10042 * sessionBackupState has not been modified yet, but runningBackups has
10043 * already been incremented. When it's false, then it's invoked as a
10044 * before_shmem_exit handler, and therefore we must not change state
10045 * unless sessionBackupState indicates that a backup is actually running.
10046 *
10047 * NB: This gets used as a PG_ENSURE_ERROR_CLEANUP callback and
10048 * before_shmem_exit handler, hence the odd-looking signature.
10049 */
10050void
10052{
10054
10055 /* If called during backup start, there shouldn't be one already running */
10057
10059 {
10063
10066
10069 errmsg("aborting backup due to backend exiting before pg_backup_stop was called"));
10070 }
10071}
10072
10073/*
10074 * Register a handler that will warn about unterminated backups at end of
10075 * session, unless this has already been done.
10076 */
10077void
10079{
10080 static bool already_done = false;
10081
10082 if (already_done)
10083 return;
10085 already_done = true;
10086}
10087
10088/*
10089 * Get latest WAL insert pointer
10090 */
10093{
10096
10097 SpinLockAcquire(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
10098 current_bytepos = Insert->CurrBytePos;
10099 SpinLockRelease(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
10100
10102}
10103
10104/*
10105 * Get latest WAL record end pointer
10106 */
10109{
10112
10113 SpinLockAcquire(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
10114 current_bytepos = Insert->CurrBytePos;
10115 SpinLockRelease(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
10116
10118}
10119
10120/*
10121 * Get latest WAL write pointer
10122 */
10125{
10127
10128 return LogwrtResult.Write;
10129}
10130
10131/*
10132 * Returns the redo pointer of the last checkpoint or restartpoint. This is
10133 * the oldest point in WAL that we still need, if we have to restart recovery.
10134 */
10135void
10143
10144/* Thin wrapper around ShutdownWalRcv(). */
10145void
10153
10154/* Enable WAL file recycling and preallocation. */
10155void
10162
10163/* Disable WAL file recycling and preallocation. */
10164void
10171
10172bool
10183
10184/*
10185 * Update the WalWriterSleeping flag.
10186 */
10187void
Datum idx(PG_FUNCTION_ARGS)
Definition _int_op.c:263
static void pg_atomic_write_u64(volatile pg_atomic_uint64 *ptr, uint64 val)
Definition atomics.h:485
#define pg_memory_barrier()
Definition atomics.h:141
#define pg_read_barrier()
Definition atomics.h:154
static uint64 pg_atomic_read_membarrier_u64(volatile pg_atomic_uint64 *ptr)
Definition atomics.h:476
#define pg_write_barrier()
Definition atomics.h:155
static uint64 pg_atomic_monotonic_advance_u64(volatile pg_atomic_uint64 *ptr, uint64 target)
Definition atomics.h:595
static uint64 pg_atomic_fetch_add_u64(volatile pg_atomic_uint64 *ptr, int64 add_)
Definition atomics.h:532
static void pg_atomic_init_u64(volatile pg_atomic_uint64 *ptr, uint64 val)
Definition atomics.h:453
static void pg_atomic_write_membarrier_u64(volatile pg_atomic_uint64 *ptr, uint64 val)
Definition atomics.h:504
static uint64 pg_atomic_read_u64(volatile pg_atomic_uint64 *ptr)
Definition atomics.h:467
TimeLineID findNewestTimeLine(TimeLineID startTLI)
Definition timeline.c:265
void restoreTimeLineHistoryFiles(TimeLineID begin, TimeLineID end)
Definition timeline.c:51
void writeTimeLineHistory(TimeLineID newTLI, TimeLineID parentTLI, XLogRecPtr switchpoint, char *reason)
Definition timeline.c:305
void startup_progress_timeout_handler(void)
Definition startup.c:302
long TimestampDifferenceMilliseconds(TimestampTz start_time, TimestampTz stop_time)
Definition timestamp.c:1765
bool TimestampDifferenceExceeds(TimestampTz start_time, TimestampTz stop_time, int msec)
Definition timestamp.c:1789
TimestampTz GetCurrentTimestamp(void)
Definition timestamp.c:1649
const char * timestamptz_to_str(TimestampTz t)
Definition timestamp.c:1870
Datum now(PG_FUNCTION_ARGS)
Definition timestamp.c:1613
static bool backup_started_in_recovery
Definition basebackup.c:129
int Buffer
Definition buf.h:23
void CheckPointBuffers(int flags)
Definition bufmgr.c:4441
void UnlockReleaseBuffer(Buffer buffer)
Definition bufmgr.c:5612
#define Min(x, y)
Definition c.h:1091
#define pg_attribute_unused()
Definition c.h:149
#define likely(x)
Definition c.h:437
#define MAXALIGN(LEN)
Definition c.h:896
#define TYPEALIGN(ALIGNVAL, LEN)
Definition c.h:889
uint8_t uint8
Definition c.h:622
#define Max(x, y)
Definition c.h:1085
#define Assert(condition)
Definition c.h:943
#define PG_BINARY
Definition c.h:1374
#define pg_attribute_always_inline
Definition c.h:305
uint64_t uint64
Definition c.h:625
#define unlikely(x)
Definition c.h:438
uint32_t uint32
Definition c.h:624
#define MAXALIGN64(LEN)
Definition c.h:921
#define PG_UINT64_MAX
Definition c.h:677
#define MemSet(start, val, len)
Definition c.h:1107
uint32 TransactionId
Definition c.h:736
size_t Size
Definition c.h:689
#define CATALOG_VERSION_NO
Definition catversion.h:60
void WakeupCheckpointer(void)
void AbsorbSyncRequests(void)
double CheckPointCompletionTarget
void RequestCheckpoint(int flags)
ChecksumStateType
Definition checksum.h:27
@ PG_DATA_CHECKSUM_VERSION
Definition checksum.h:29
@ PG_DATA_CHECKSUM_INPROGRESS_OFF
Definition checksum.h:30
@ PG_DATA_CHECKSUM_INPROGRESS_ON
Definition checksum.h:31
@ PG_DATA_CHECKSUM_OFF
Definition checksum.h:28
uint32 result
memcpy(sums, checksumBaseOffsets, sizeof(checksumBaseOffsets))
void BootStrapCLOG(void)
Definition clog.c:851
void StartupCLOG(void)
Definition clog.c:862
void CheckPointCLOG(void)
Definition clog.c:922
void TrimCLOG(void)
Definition clog.c:877
void StartupCommitTs(void)
Definition commit_ts.c:613
void CommitTsParameterChange(bool newvalue, bool oldvalue)
Definition commit_ts.c:645
bool track_commit_timestamp
Definition commit_ts.c:121
void CompleteCommitTsInitialization(void)
Definition commit_ts.c:623
void BootStrapCommitTs(void)
Definition commit_ts.c:599
void SetCommitTsLimit(TransactionId oldestXact, TransactionId newestXact)
Definition commit_ts.c:892
void CheckPointCommitTs(void)
Definition commit_ts.c:799
void update_controlfile(const char *DataDir, ControlFileData *ControlFile, bool do_sync)
#define fprintf(file, fmt, msg)
Definition cubescan.l:21
void EmitAndWaitDataChecksumsBarrier(uint32 state)
int64 TimestampTz
Definition timestamp.h:39
Datum arg
Definition elog.c:1323
int errcode_for_file_access(void)
Definition elog.c:898
int errcode(int sqlerrcode)
Definition elog.c:875
#define _(x)
Definition elog.c:96
#define LOG
Definition elog.h:32
int errhint(const char *fmt,...) pg_attribute_printf(1
int errdetail(const char *fmt,...) pg_attribute_printf(1
#define FATAL
Definition elog.h:42
int int errmsg_internal(const char *fmt,...) pg_attribute_printf(1
#define WARNING
Definition elog.h:37
int int int errmsg_plural(const char *fmt_singular, const char *fmt_plural, unsigned long n,...) pg_attribute_printf(1
#define DEBUG2
Definition elog.h:30
#define PANIC
Definition elog.h:44
#define DEBUG1
Definition elog.h:31
#define ERROR
Definition elog.h:40
#define elog(elevel,...)
Definition elog.h:228
#define NOTICE
Definition elog.h:36
#define ereport(elevel,...)
Definition elog.h:152
int MakePGDirectory(const char *directoryName)
Definition fd.c:3963
int FreeDir(DIR *dir)
Definition fd.c:3009
int pg_fsync_no_writethrough(int fd)
Definition fd.c:442
int io_direct_flags
Definition fd.c:172
int durable_rename(const char *oldfile, const char *newfile, int elevel)
Definition fd.c:783
int pg_fdatasync(int fd)
Definition fd.c:481
int CloseTransientFile(int fd)
Definition fd.c:2855
int BasicOpenFile(const char *fileName, int fileFlags)
Definition fd.c:1090
int FreeFile(FILE *file)
Definition fd.c:2827
int pg_fsync_writethrough(int fd)
Definition fd.c:462
void ReleaseExternalFD(void)
Definition fd.c:1225
int data_sync_elevel(int elevel)
Definition fd.c:3986
static void Insert(File file)
Definition fd.c:1301
DIR * AllocateDir(const char *dirname)
Definition fd.c:2891
int durable_unlink(const char *fname, int elevel)
Definition fd.c:873
void ReserveExternalFD(void)
Definition fd.c:1207
struct dirent * ReadDir(DIR *dir, const char *dirname)
Definition fd.c:2957
int pg_fsync(int fd)
Definition fd.c:390
FILE * AllocateFile(const char *name, const char *mode)
Definition fd.c:2628
int OpenTransientFile(const char *fileName, int fileFlags)
Definition fd.c:2678
void SyncDataDirectory(void)
Definition fd.c:3594
#define IO_DIRECT_WAL
Definition fd.h:55
#define IO_DIRECT_WAL_INIT
Definition fd.h:56
#define PG_O_DIRECT
Definition fd.h:123
#define palloc_object(type)
Definition fe_memutils.h:89
ssize_t pg_pwrite_zeros(int fd, size_t size, pgoff_t offset)
Definition file_utils.c:709
PGFileType get_dirent_type(const char *path, const struct dirent *de, bool look_through_symlinks, int elevel)
Definition file_utils.c:547
PGFileType
Definition file_utils.h:19
@ PGFILETYPE_LNK
Definition file_utils.h:24
@ PGFILETYPE_DIR
Definition file_utils.h:23
@ PGFILETYPE_REG
Definition file_utils.h:22
bool IsBinaryUpgrade
Definition globals.c:123
int NBuffers
Definition globals.c:144
pid_t PostmasterPid
Definition globals.c:108
volatile uint32 InterruptHoldoffCount
Definition globals.c:43
bool enableFsync
Definition globals.c:131
ProcNumber MyProcNumber
Definition globals.c:92
bool IsUnderPostmaster
Definition globals.c:122
int MaxConnections
Definition globals.c:145
volatile uint32 CritSectionCount
Definition globals.c:45
char * DataDir
Definition globals.c:73
bool IsPostmasterEnvironment
Definition globals.c:121
struct Latch * MyLatch
Definition globals.c:65
int max_worker_processes
Definition globals.c:146
int set_config_option_ext(const char *name, const char *value, GucContext context, GucSource source, Oid srole, GucAction action, bool changeVal, int elevel, bool is_reload)
Definition guc.c:3288
void SetConfigOption(const char *name, const char *value, GucContext context, GucSource source)
Definition guc.c:4234
void * guc_malloc(int elevel, size_t size)
Definition guc.c:637
#define newval
struct config_generic * find_option(const char *name, bool create_placeholders, bool skip_errors, int elevel)
Definition guc.c:1114
@ GUC_ACTION_SET
Definition guc.h:203
#define GUC_check_errdetail
Definition guc.h:507
GucSource
Definition guc.h:112
@ PGC_S_DYNAMIC_DEFAULT
Definition guc.h:114
@ PGC_S_OVERRIDE
Definition guc.h:123
@ PGC_INTERNAL
Definition guc.h:73
@ PGC_POSTMASTER
Definition guc.h:74
return str start
#define TOAST_MAX_CHUNK_SIZE
Definition heaptoast.h:84
#define bufsize
#define INJECTION_POINT(name, arg)
#define INJECTION_POINT_CACHED(name, arg)
#define INJECTION_POINT_LOAD(name)
WalUsage pgWalUsage
Definition instrument.c:27
#define close(a)
Definition win32.h:12
#define write(a, b, c)
Definition win32.h:14
#define read(a, b, c)
Definition win32.h:13
void before_shmem_exit(pg_on_exit_callback function, Datum arg)
Definition ipc.c:344
#define PG_ENSURE_ERROR_CLEANUP(cleanup_function, arg)
Definition ipc.h:47
#define PG_END_ENSURE_ERROR_CLEANUP(cleanup_function, arg)
Definition ipc.h:52
int i
Definition isn.c:77
#define LOBLKSIZE
void SetLatch(Latch *latch)
Definition latch.c:290
void ResetLatch(Latch *latch)
Definition latch.c:374
int WaitLatch(Latch *latch, int wakeEvents, long timeout, uint32 wait_event_info)
Definition latch.c:172
List * lappend(List *list, void *datum)
Definition list.c:339
void list_free(List *list)
Definition list.c:1546
int max_locks_per_xact
Definition lock.c:56
void UpdateLogicalDecodingStatusEndOfRecovery(void)
Definition logicalctl.c:551
bool IsLogicalDecodingEnabled(void)
Definition logicalctl.c:202
bool IsXLogLogicalInfoEnabled(void)
Definition logicalctl.c:218
void StartupLogicalDecodingStatus(bool last_status)
Definition logicalctl.c:144
void DisableLogicalDecoding(void)
Definition logicalctl.c:489
void EnableLogicalDecoding(void)
Definition logicalctl.c:338
void LWLockUpdateVar(LWLock *lock, pg_atomic_uint64 *valptr, uint64 val)
Definition lwlock.c:1702
void LWLockReleaseClearVar(LWLock *lock, pg_atomic_uint64 *valptr, uint64 val)
Definition lwlock.c:1840
bool LWLockAcquire(LWLock *lock, LWLockMode mode)
Definition lwlock.c:1150
bool LWLockWaitForVar(LWLock *lock, pg_atomic_uint64 *valptr, uint64 oldval, uint64 *newval)
Definition lwlock.c:1566
void LWLockRelease(LWLock *lock)
Definition lwlock.c:1767
void LWLockInitialize(LWLock *lock, int tranche_id)
Definition lwlock.c:670
bool LWLockConditionalAcquire(LWLock *lock, LWLockMode mode)
Definition lwlock.c:1321
bool LWLockAcquireOrWait(LWLock *lock, LWLockMode mode)
Definition lwlock.c:1378
@ LW_SHARED
Definition lwlock.h:105
@ LW_EXCLUSIVE
Definition lwlock.h:104
Size add_size(Size s1, Size s2)
Definition mcxt.c:1733
char * pstrdup(const char *in)
Definition mcxt.c:1910
void pfree(void *pointer)
Definition mcxt.c:1619
MemoryContext TopMemoryContext
Definition mcxt.c:167
Size mul_size(Size s1, Size s2)
Definition mcxt.c:1752
void * palloc(Size size)
Definition mcxt.c:1390
void MemoryContextAllowInCriticalSection(MemoryContext context, bool allow)
Definition mcxt.c:746
#define AllocSetContextCreate
Definition memutils.h:129
#define ALLOCSET_DEFAULT_SIZES
Definition memutils.h:160
#define AmStartupProcess()
Definition miscadmin.h:405
#define IsBootstrapProcessingMode()
Definition miscadmin.h:495
#define START_CRIT_SECTION()
Definition miscadmin.h:152
#define CHECK_FOR_INTERRUPTS()
Definition miscadmin.h:125
@ B_CHECKPOINTER
Definition miscadmin.h:375
#define END_CRIT_SECTION()
Definition miscadmin.h:154
#define AmWalReceiverProcess()
Definition miscadmin.h:406
bool process_shared_preload_libraries_done
Definition miscinit.c:1789
BackendType MyBackendType
Definition miscinit.c:65
void MultiXactSetNextMXact(MultiXactId nextMulti, MultiXactOffset nextMultiOffset)
Definition multixact.c:2063
void MultiXactAdvanceOldest(MultiXactId oldestMulti, Oid oldestMultiDB)
Definition multixact.c:2266
void MultiXactGetCheckptMulti(bool is_shutdown, MultiXactId *nextMulti, MultiXactOffset *nextMultiOffset, MultiXactId *oldestMulti, Oid *oldestMultiDB)
Definition multixact.c:2017
void CheckPointMultiXact(void)
Definition multixact.c:2039
void TrimMultiXact(void)
Definition multixact.c:1904
void MultiXactAdvanceNextMXact(MultiXactId minMulti, MultiXactOffset minMultiOffset)
Definition multixact.c:2239
void BootStrapMultiXact(void)
Definition multixact.c:1863
void StartupMultiXact(void)
Definition multixact.c:1879
void SetMultiXactIdLimit(MultiXactId oldest_datminmxid, Oid oldest_datoid)
Definition multixact.c:2085
#define FirstMultiXactId
Definition multixact.h:26
static char * errmsg
void StartupReplicationOrigin(void)
Definition origin.c:740
void CheckPointReplicationOrigin(void)
Definition origin.c:614
static MemoryContext MemoryContextSwitchTo(MemoryContext context)
Definition palloc.h:138
#define ERRCODE_DATA_CORRUPTED
#define INDEX_MAX_KEYS
#define NAMEDATALEN
#define MAXPGPATH
#define DEFAULT_XLOG_SEG_SIZE
#define SLRU_PAGES_PER_SEGMENT
#define PG_IO_ALIGN_SIZE
#define PG_CACHE_LINE_SIZE
#define FLOATFORMAT_VALUE
Definition pg_control.h:209
#define XLOG_RESTORE_POINT
Definition pg_control.h:79
#define XLOG_FPW_CHANGE
Definition pg_control.h:80
#define XLOG_CHECKPOINT_REDO
Definition pg_control.h:86
#define PG_CONTROL_VERSION
Definition pg_control.h:25
#define XLOG_OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD
Definition pg_control.h:85
#define XLOG_ASSIGN_LSN
Definition pg_control.h:84
#define XLOG_FPI
Definition pg_control.h:83
#define XLOG_FPI_FOR_HINT
Definition pg_control.h:82
#define MOCK_AUTH_NONCE_LEN
Definition pg_control.h:28
#define XLOG2_CHECKSUMS
Definition pg_control.h:90
#define XLOG_NEXTOID
Definition pg_control.h:75
@ DB_IN_PRODUCTION
Definition pg_control.h:105
@ DB_SHUTDOWNING
Definition pg_control.h:102
@ DB_IN_ARCHIVE_RECOVERY
Definition pg_control.h:104
@ DB_SHUTDOWNED_IN_RECOVERY
Definition pg_control.h:101
@ DB_SHUTDOWNED
Definition pg_control.h:100
@ DB_IN_CRASH_RECOVERY
Definition pg_control.h:103
#define XLOG_NOOP
Definition pg_control.h:74
#define XLOG_CHECKPOINT_SHUTDOWN
Definition pg_control.h:72
#define PG_CONTROL_FILE_SIZE
Definition pg_control.h:266
#define XLOG_SWITCH
Definition pg_control.h:76
#define XLOG_BACKUP_END
Definition pg_control.h:77
#define XLOG_PARAMETER_CHANGE
Definition pg_control.h:78
#define XLOG_LOGICAL_DECODING_STATUS_CHANGE
Definition pg_control.h:87
#define XLOG_CHECKPOINT_ONLINE
Definition pg_control.h:73
#define XLOG_END_OF_RECOVERY
Definition pg_control.h:81
uint32 pg_crc32c
Definition pg_crc32c.h:38
#define COMP_CRC32C(crc, data, len)
Definition pg_crc32c.h:177
#define EQ_CRC32C(c1, c2)
Definition pg_crc32c.h:42
#define INIT_CRC32C(crc)
Definition pg_crc32c.h:41
#define FIN_CRC32C(crc)
Definition pg_crc32c.h:182
const void size_t len
return crc
static char * filename
Definition pg_dumpall.c:133
#define lfirst(lc)
Definition pg_list.h:172
static rewind_source * source
Definition pg_rewind.c:89
static char buf[DEFAULT_XLOG_SEG_SIZE]
static THREAD_BARRIER_T barrier
Definition pgbench.c:488
bool pgstat_report_fixed
Definition pgstat.c:219
void pgstat_restore_stats(void)
Definition pgstat.c:525
void pgstat_discard_stats(void)
Definition pgstat.c:537
@ IOOBJECT_WAL
Definition pgstat.h:283
@ IOCONTEXT_INIT
Definition pgstat.h:292
@ IOCONTEXT_NORMAL
Definition pgstat.h:293
@ IOOP_FSYNC
Definition pgstat.h:312
@ IOOP_WRITE
Definition pgstat.h:320
PgStat_CheckpointerStats PendingCheckpointerStats
instr_time pgstat_prepare_io_time(bool track_io_guc)
Definition pgstat_io.c:91
void pgstat_count_io_op_time(IOObject io_object, IOContext io_context, IOOp io_op, instr_time start_time, uint32 cnt, uint64 bytes)
Definition pgstat_io.c:122
int64 pg_time_t
Definition pgtime.h:23
size_t pg_strftime(char *s, size_t maxsize, const char *format, const struct pg_tm *t)
Definition strftime.c:135
struct pg_tm * pg_localtime(const pg_time_t *timep, const pg_tz *tz)
Definition localtime.c:1347
PGDLLIMPORT pg_tz * log_timezone
Definition pgtz.c:31
bool pg_strong_random(void *buf, size_t len)
int pg_strcasecmp(const char *s1, const char *s2)
#define pg_pwrite
Definition port.h:249
#define snprintf
Definition port.h:261
#define IS_DIR_SEP(ch)
Definition port.h:104
size_t strlcpy(char *dst, const char *src, size_t siz)
Definition strlcpy.c:45
static bool DatumGetBool(Datum X)
Definition postgres.h:100
static Datum BoolGetDatum(bool X)
Definition postgres.h:112
uint64_t Datum
Definition postgres.h:70
#define InvalidOid
unsigned int Oid
void CheckPointPredicate(void)
Definition predicate.c:1022
static int fd(const char *x, int i)
static int fb(int x)
short access
#define GetPGProcByNumber(n)
Definition proc.h:504
#define DELAY_CHKPT_START
Definition proc.h:139
#define DELAY_CHKPT_COMPLETE
Definition proc.h:140
bool MinimumActiveBackends(int min)
Definition procarray.c:3589
TransactionId GetOldestTransactionIdConsideredRunning(void)
Definition procarray.c:1973
bool HaveVirtualXIDsDelayingChkpt(VirtualTransactionId *vxids, int nvxids, int type)
Definition procarray.c:3062
void ProcArrayApplyRecoveryInfo(RunningTransactions running)
Definition procarray.c:1045
TransactionId GetOldestActiveTransactionId(bool inCommitOnly, bool allDbs)
Definition procarray.c:2845
void ProcArrayInitRecovery(TransactionId initializedUptoXID)
Definition procarray.c:1014
VirtualTransactionId * GetVirtualXIDsDelayingChkpt(int *nvxids, int type)
Definition procarray.c:3017
#define INVALID_PROC_NUMBER
Definition procnumber.h:26
int ProcNumber
Definition procnumber.h:24
void WaitForProcSignalBarrier(uint64 generation)
Definition procsignal.c:428
uint64 EmitProcSignalBarrier(ProcSignalBarrierType type)
Definition procsignal.c:360
@ PROCSIGNAL_BARRIER_CHECKSUM_INPROGRESS_OFF
Definition procsignal.h:55
@ PROCSIGNAL_BARRIER_CHECKSUM_INPROGRESS_ON
Definition procsignal.h:54
@ PROCSIGNAL_BARRIER_CHECKSUM_ON
Definition procsignal.h:56
@ PROCSIGNAL_BARRIER_CHECKSUM_OFF
Definition procsignal.h:53
static void set_ps_display(const char *activity)
Definition ps_status.h:40
void ResetUnloggedRelations(int op)
Definition reinit.c:47
#define UNLOGGED_RELATION_INIT
Definition reinit.h:28
#define UNLOGGED_RELATION_CLEANUP
Definition reinit.h:27
void RelationCacheInitFileRemove(void)
Definition relcache.c:6926
void CheckPointRelationMap(void)
Definition relmapper.c:612
#define relpath(rlocator, forknum)
Definition relpath.h:150
#define PG_TBLSPC_DIR
Definition relpath.h:41
void StartupReorderBuffer(void)
ResourceOwner CurrentResourceOwner
Definition resowner.c:173
ResourceOwner AuxProcessResourceOwner
Definition resowner.c:176
void CheckPointLogicalRewriteHeap(void)
#define RM_MAX_ID
Definition rmgr.h:33
#define ShmemRequestStruct(...)
Definition shmem.h:176
void pg_usleep(long microsec)
Definition signal.c:53
void CheckPointReplicationSlots(bool is_shutdown)
Definition slot.c:2324
void StartupReplicationSlots(void)
Definition slot.c:2402
bool InvalidateObsoleteReplicationSlots(uint32 possible_causes, XLogSegNo oldestSegno, Oid dboid, TransactionId snapshotConflictHorizon)
Definition slot.c:2220
@ RS_INVAL_WAL_REMOVED
Definition slot.h:62
@ RS_INVAL_IDLE_TIMEOUT
Definition slot.h:68
@ RS_INVAL_WAL_LEVEL
Definition slot.h:66
bool sync_replication_slots
Definition slotsync.c:132
void smgrdestroyall(void)
Definition smgr.c:386
void CheckPointSnapBuild(void)
Definition snapbuild.c:2030
void DeleteAllExportedSnapshotFiles(void)
Definition snapmgr.c:1587
static void SpinLockRelease(volatile slock_t *lock)
Definition spin.h:62
static void SpinLockAcquire(volatile slock_t *lock)
Definition spin.h:56
static void SpinLockInit(volatile slock_t *lock)
Definition spin.h:50
void reset(void)
PGPROC * MyProc
Definition proc.c:71
PROC_HDR * ProcGlobal
Definition proc.c:74
void InitRecoveryTransactionEnvironment(void)
Definition standby.c:96
XLogRecPtr LogStandbySnapshot(Oid dbid)
Definition standby.c:1303
void ShutdownRecoveryTransactionEnvironment(void)
Definition standby.c:162
@ SUBXIDS_IN_SUBTRANS
Definition standby.h:123
void appendStringInfo(StringInfo str, const char *fmt,...)
Definition stringinfo.c:145
void appendBinaryStringInfo(StringInfo str, const void *data, int datalen)
Definition stringinfo.c:281
void appendStringInfoString(StringInfo str, const char *s)
Definition stringinfo.c:230
void appendStringInfoChar(StringInfo str, char ch)
Definition stringinfo.c:242
void initStringInfo(StringInfo str)
Definition stringinfo.c:97
Oid oldestMultiDB
Definition pg_control.h:52
MultiXactId oldestMulti
Definition pg_control.h:51
MultiXactOffset nextMultiOffset
Definition pg_control.h:48
TransactionId newestCommitTsXid
Definition pg_control.h:56
TransactionId oldestXid
Definition pg_control.h:49
TimeLineID PrevTimeLineID
Definition pg_control.h:40
TimeLineID ThisTimeLineID
Definition pg_control.h:39
TransactionId oldestActiveXid
Definition pg_control.h:65
bool fullPageWrites
Definition pg_control.h:42
MultiXactId nextMulti
Definition pg_control.h:47
FullTransactionId nextXid
Definition pg_control.h:45
TransactionId oldestCommitTsXid
Definition pg_control.h:54
pg_time_t time
Definition pg_control.h:53
int wal_level
Definition pg_control.h:43
bool logicalDecodingEnabled
Definition pg_control.h:44
uint32 dataChecksumState
Definition pg_control.h:68
XLogRecPtr redo
Definition pg_control.h:37
Oid oldestXidDB
Definition pg_control.h:50
uint64 ckpt_agg_sync_time
Definition xlog.h:188
uint64 ckpt_longest_sync
Definition xlog.h:187
TimestampTz ckpt_start_t
Definition xlog.h:173
TimestampTz ckpt_end_t
Definition xlog.h:177
int ckpt_segs_removed
Definition xlog.h:183
TimestampTz ckpt_write_t
Definition xlog.h:174
TimestampTz ckpt_sync_end_t
Definition xlog.h:176
TimestampTz ckpt_sync_t
Definition xlog.h:175
int ckpt_bufs_written
Definition xlog.h:179
int ckpt_segs_recycled
Definition xlog.h:184
int ckpt_slru_written
Definition xlog.h:180
char mock_authentication_nonce[MOCK_AUTH_NONCE_LEN]
Definition pg_control.h:245
uint32 pg_control_version
Definition pg_control.h:133
uint32 xlog_seg_size
Definition pg_control.h:221
XLogRecPtr backupStartPoint
Definition pg_control.h:178
bool track_commit_timestamp
Definition pg_control.h:193
CheckPoint checkPointCopy
Definition pg_control.h:143
uint32 slru_pages_per_segment
Definition pg_control.h:218
XLogRecPtr backupEndPoint
Definition pg_control.h:179
XLogRecPtr minRecoveryPoint
Definition pg_control.h:176
uint32 data_checksum_version
Definition pg_control.h:232
XLogRecPtr unloggedLSN
Definition pg_control.h:145
uint32 indexMaxKeys
Definition pg_control.h:224
pg_time_t time
Definition pg_control.h:140
bool default_char_signedness
Definition pg_control.h:238
XLogRecPtr checkPoint
Definition pg_control.h:141
uint64 system_identifier
Definition pg_control.h:118
uint32 catalog_version_no
Definition pg_control.h:134
TimeLineID minRecoveryPointTLI
Definition pg_control.h:177
pg_crc32c crc
Definition pg_control.h:248
uint32 toast_max_chunk_size
Definition pg_control.h:226
Definition dirent.c:26
Definition pg_list.h:54
char data[XLOG_BLCKSZ]
Definition c.h:1231
int delayChkptFlags
Definition proc.h:260
ProcNumber walwriterProc
Definition proc.h:488
PgStat_Counter sync_time
Definition pgstat.h:269
PgStat_Counter write_time
Definition pgstat.h:268
void(* rm_mask)(char *pagedata, BlockNumber blkno)
TransactionId oldestRunningXid
Definition standby.h:134
TransactionId nextXid
Definition standby.h:133
TransactionId latestCompletedXid
Definition standby.h:137
subxids_array_status subxid_status
Definition standby.h:132
TransactionId * xids
Definition standby.h:139
ShmemRequestCallback request_fn
Definition shmem.h:133
TransactionId oldestCommitTsXid
Definition transam.h:232
TransactionId newestCommitTsXid
Definition transam.h:233
FullTransactionId latestCompletedXid
Definition transam.h:238
FullTransactionId nextXid
Definition transam.h:220
TransactionId oldestXid
Definition transam.h:222
pg_atomic_uint64 insertingAt
Definition xlog.c:377
XLogRecPtr lastImportantAt
Definition xlog.c:378
LWLock lock
Definition xlog.c:376
int64 wal_buffers_full
Definition instrument.h:57
uint64 wal_bytes
Definition instrument.h:55
int64 wal_fpi
Definition instrument.h:54
uint64 wal_fpi_bytes
Definition instrument.h:56
int64 wal_records
Definition instrument.h:53
CheckPoint lastCheckPoint
Definition xlog.c:551
XLogwrtRqst LogwrtRqst
Definition xlog.c:462
slock_t info_lck
Definition xlog.c:562
XLogRecPtr InitializedUpTo
Definition xlog.c:491
char * pages
Definition xlog.c:498
pg_time_t lastSegSwitchTime
Definition xlog.c:473
XLogRecPtr replicationSlotMinLSN
Definition xlog.c:465
RecoveryState SharedRecoveryState
Definition xlog.c:522
uint32 data_checksum_version
Definition xlog.c:560
TimeLineID InsertTimeLineID
Definition xlog.c:515
XLogRecPtr lastSegSwitchLSN
Definition xlog.c:474
XLogSegNo lastRemovedSegNo
Definition xlog.c:467
pg_atomic_uint64 * xlblocks
Definition xlog.c:499
pg_atomic_uint64 logWriteResult
Definition xlog.c:478
int XLogCacheBlck
Definition xlog.c:500
XLogRecPtr RedoRecPtr
Definition xlog.c:463
XLogRecPtr lastCheckPointRecPtr
Definition xlog.c:549
XLogRecPtr lastFpwDisableRecPtr
Definition xlog.c:557
XLogCtlInsert Insert
Definition xlog.c:459
bool InstallXLogFileSegmentActive
Definition xlog.c:532
bool WalWriterSleeping
Definition xlog.c:539
XLogRecPtr asyncXactLSN
Definition xlog.c:464
XLogRecPtr lastCheckPointEndPtr
Definition xlog.c:550
pg_atomic_uint64 logFlushResult
Definition xlog.c:479
pg_atomic_uint64 logInsertResult
Definition xlog.c:477
TimeLineID PrevTimeLineID
Definition xlog.c:516
pg_atomic_uint64 unloggedLSN
Definition xlog.c:470
WALInsertLockPadded * WALInsertLocks
Definition xlog.c:451
XLogRecPtr RedoRecPtr
Definition xlog.c:437
uint64 PrevBytePos
Definition xlog.c:415
char pad[PG_CACHE_LINE_SIZE]
Definition xlog.c:424
int runningBackups
Definition xlog.c:445
slock_t insertpos_lck
Definition xlog.c:405
uint64 CurrBytePos
Definition xlog.c:414
bool fullPageWrites
Definition xlog.c:438
XLogRecPtr lastBackupStart
Definition xlog.c:446
XLogRecPtr xlp_pageaddr
XLogRecPtr EndRecPtr
Definition xlogreader.h:206
XLogRecPtr ReadRecPtr
Definition xlogreader.h:205
XLogRecPtr xl_prev
Definition xlogrecord.h:45
pg_crc32c xl_crc
Definition xlogrecord.h:49
uint8 xl_info
Definition xlogrecord.h:46
uint32 xl_tot_len
Definition xlogrecord.h:43
TransactionId xl_xid
Definition xlogrecord.h:44
RmgrId xl_rmid
Definition xlogrecord.h:47
XLogRecPtr Flush
Definition xlog.c:335
XLogRecPtr Write
Definition xlog.c:334
XLogRecPtr Flush
Definition xlog.c:329
XLogRecPtr Write
Definition xlog.c:328
Definition guc.h:174
ChecksumStateType new_checksum_state
TimestampTz rp_time
void StartupSUBTRANS(TransactionId oldestActiveXID)
Definition subtrans.c:302
void CheckPointSUBTRANS(void)
Definition subtrans.c:348
void BootStrapSUBTRANS(void)
Definition subtrans.c:288
void TruncateSUBTRANS(TransactionId oldestXact)
Definition subtrans.c:404
void ProcessSyncRequests(void)
Definition sync.c:287
void SyncPreCheckpoint(void)
Definition sync.c:178
void SyncPostCheckpoint(void)
Definition sync.c:203
TimeoutId RegisterTimeout(TimeoutId id, timeout_handler_proc handler)
Definition timeout.c:505
@ STARTUP_PROGRESS_TIMEOUT
Definition timeout.h:38
#define TransactionIdRetreat(dest)
Definition transam.h:141
#define InvalidTransactionId
Definition transam.h:31
static void FullTransactionIdRetreat(FullTransactionId *dest)
Definition transam.h:103
#define XidFromFullTransactionId(x)
Definition transam.h:48
#define FirstGenbkiObjectId
Definition transam.h:195
#define FirstNormalTransactionId
Definition transam.h:34
#define TransactionIdIsValid(xid)
Definition transam.h:41
static FullTransactionId FullTransactionIdFromEpochAndXid(uint32 epoch, TransactionId xid)
Definition transam.h:71
#define TransactionIdIsNormal(xid)
Definition transam.h:42
#define FullTransactionIdPrecedes(a, b)
Definition transam.h:51
static bool TransactionIdPrecedes(TransactionId id1, TransactionId id2)
Definition transam.h:263
void RecoverPreparedTransactions(void)
Definition twophase.c:2089
void restoreTwoPhaseData(void)
Definition twophase.c:1910
int max_prepared_xacts
Definition twophase.c:118
TransactionId PrescanPreparedTransactions(TransactionId **xids_p, int *nxids_p)
Definition twophase.c:1972
void StandbyRecoverPreparedTransactions(void)
Definition twophase.c:2051
void CheckPointTwoPhase(XLogRecPtr redo_horizon)
Definition twophase.c:1828
WALInsertLock l
Definition xlog.c:390
char pad[PG_CACHE_LINE_SIZE]
Definition xlog.c:391
bool SplitIdentifierString(char *rawstring, char separator, List **namelist)
Definition varlena.c:2870
void SetTransactionIdLimit(TransactionId oldest_datfrozenxid, Oid oldest_datoid)
Definition varsup.c:367
void AdvanceOldestClogXid(TransactionId oldest_datfrozenxid)
Definition varsup.c:350
TransamVariablesData * TransamVariables
Definition varsup.c:37
static void pgstat_report_wait_start(uint32 wait_event_info)
Definition wait_event.h:67
static void pgstat_report_wait_end(void)
Definition wait_event.h:83
const char * name
#define WL_TIMEOUT
#define WL_EXIT_ON_PM_DEATH
#define WL_LATCH_SET
static TimestampTz wakeup[NUM_WALRCV_WAKEUPS]
XLogRecPtr Flush
XLogRecPtr Write
XLogRecPtr GetWalRcvFlushRecPtr(XLogRecPtr *latestChunkStart, TimeLineID *receiveTLI)
void ShutdownWalRcv(void)
void WalSndWakeup(bool physical, bool logical)
Definition walsender.c:4012
int max_wal_senders
Definition walsender.c:141
void WalSndInitStopping(void)
Definition walsender.c:4091
void WalSndWaitStopping(void)
Definition walsender.c:4117
static void WalSndWakeupProcessRequests(bool physical, bool logical)
Definition walsender.h:64
#define WalSndWakeupRequest()
Definition walsender.h:57
bool summarize_wal
void WaitForWalSummarization(XLogRecPtr lsn)
void WakeupWalSummarizer(void)
XLogRecPtr GetOldestUnsummarizedLSN(TimeLineID *tli, bool *lsn_is_exact)
int WalWriterFlushAfter
Definition walwriter.c:72
int WalWriterDelay
Definition walwriter.c:71
#define stat
Definition win32_port.h:74
#define EINTR
Definition win32_port.h:361
#define S_ISDIR(m)
Definition win32_port.h:315
#define kill(pid, sig)
Definition win32_port.h:490
#define SIGUSR1
Definition win32_port.h:170
#define readlink(path, buf, size)
Definition win32_port.h:226
#define O_CLOEXEC
Definition win32_port.h:344
#define O_DSYNC
Definition win32_port.h:346
int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tp, void *tzp)
void MarkSubxactTopXidLogged(void)
Definition xact.c:593
void MarkCurrentTransactionIdLoggedIfAny(void)
Definition xact.c:543
int XLogFileInit(XLogSegNo logsegno, TimeLineID logtli)
Definition xlog.c:3431
void assign_wal_sync_method(int new_wal_sync_method, void *extra)
Definition xlog.c:9316
static const char * CheckpointFlagsString(int flags)
Definition xlog.c:7148
static void CreateEndOfRecoveryRecord(void)
Definition xlog.c:7905
uint64 GetSystemIdentifier(void)
Definition xlog.c:4643
int wal_decode_buffer_size
Definition xlog.c:143
XLogRecPtr ProcLastRecPtr
Definition xlog.c:260
static XLogCtlData * XLogCtl
Definition xlog.c:575
bool fullPageWrites
Definition xlog.c:129
void UpdateFullPageWrites(void)
Definition xlog.c:8752
bool RecoveryInProgress(void)
Definition xlog.c:6832
static void CleanupBackupHistory(void)
Definition xlog.c:4212
void GetFullPageWriteInfo(XLogRecPtr *RedoRecPtr_p, bool *doPageWrites_p)
Definition xlog.c:6965
TimeLineID GetWALInsertionTimeLine(void)
Definition xlog.c:7018
static ControlFileData * LocalControlFile
Definition xlog.c:583
XLogRecPtr RequestXLogSwitch(bool mark_unimportant)
Definition xlog.c:8604
void do_pg_abort_backup(int code, Datum arg)
Definition xlog.c:10051
XLogSegNo XLogGetLastRemovedSegno(void)
Definition xlog.c:3809
XLogRecPtr XLogInsertRecord(XLogRecData *rdata, XLogRecPtr fpw_lsn, uint8 flags, int num_fpi, uint64 fpi_bytes, bool topxid_included)
Definition xlog.c:784
void SetLocalDataChecksumState(uint32 data_checksum_version)
Definition xlog.c:4971
char * XLogArchiveCommand
Definition xlog.c:127
int wal_keep_size_mb
Definition xlog.c:123
Size WALReadFromBuffers(char *dstbuf, XLogRecPtr startptr, Size count, TimeLineID tli)
Definition xlog.c:1789
static XLogRecPtr WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish(XLogRecPtr upto)
Definition xlog.c:1545
static void WALInsertLockRelease(void)
Definition xlog.c:1486
void SetDataChecksumsOff(void)
Definition xlog.c:4867
static XLogRecPtr XLogBytePosToRecPtr(uint64 bytepos)
Definition xlog.c:1899
bool EnableHotStandby
Definition xlog.c:128
static void WALInsertLockUpdateInsertingAt(XLogRecPtr insertingAt)
Definition xlog.c:1512
XLogRecPtr GetRedoRecPtr(void)
Definition xlog.c:6935
void assign_wal_consistency_checking(const char *newval, void *extra)
Definition xlog.c:5163
static void InitControlFile(uint64 sysidentifier, uint32 data_checksum_version)
Definition xlog.c:4255
void SetInstallXLogFileSegmentActive(void)
Definition xlog.c:10156
static void AdvanceXLInsertBuffer(XLogRecPtr upto, TimeLineID tli, bool opportunistic)
Definition xlog.c:2026
static void WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive(void)
Definition xlog.c:1457
static void UpdateControlFile(void)
Definition xlog.c:4634
void StartupXLOG(void)
Definition xlog.c:5847
bool IsInstallXLogFileSegmentActive(void)
Definition xlog.c:10173
static int openLogFile
Definition xlog.c:655
void BootStrapXLOG(uint32 data_checksum_version)
Definition xlog.c:5455
XLogRecPtr XactLastRecEnd
Definition xlog.c:261
bool CreateRestartPoint(int flags)
Definition xlog.c:8126
static void ValidateXLOGDirectoryStructure(void)
Definition xlog.c:4150
int CommitDelay
Definition xlog.c:139
static void RemoveOldXlogFiles(XLogSegNo segno, XLogRecPtr lastredoptr, XLogRecPtr endptr, TimeLineID insertTLI)
Definition xlog.c:3916
static XLogRecPtr CreateOverwriteContrecordRecord(XLogRecPtr aborted_lsn, XLogRecPtr pagePtr, TimeLineID newTLI)
Definition xlog.c:7976
void xlog2_redo(XLogReaderState *record)
Definition xlog.c:9235
XLogRecPtr GetInsertRecPtr(void)
Definition xlog.c:6980
bool wal_init_zero
Definition xlog.c:134
static void CalculateCheckpointSegments(void)
Definition xlog.c:2192
XLogRecPtr XLogGetReplicationSlotMinimumLSN(void)
Definition xlog.c:2700
int XLogArchiveMode
Definition xlog.c:126
SessionBackupState get_backup_status(void)
Definition xlog.c:9758
static void XLogReportParameters(void)
Definition xlog.c:8671
#define RefreshXLogWriteResult(_target)
Definition xlog.c:640
void CheckXLogRemoved(XLogSegNo segno, TimeLineID tli)
Definition xlog.c:3778
int wal_level
Definition xlog.c:138
static void LogCheckpointStart(int flags, bool restartpoint)
Definition xlog.c:7169
static XLogRecPtr RedoRecPtr
Definition xlog.c:280
void assign_checkpoint_completion_target(double newval, void *extra)
Definition xlog.c:2228
static bool InstallXLogFileSegment(XLogSegNo *segno, char *tmppath, bool find_free, XLogSegNo max_segno, TimeLineID tli)
Definition xlog.c:3614
static void WriteControlFile(void)
Definition xlog.c:4296
int wal_segment_size
Definition xlog.c:150
WALAvailability GetWALAvailability(XLogRecPtr targetLSN)
Definition xlog.c:8411
const char * show_archive_command(void)
Definition xlog.c:5216
#define UsableBytesInPage
Definition xlog.c:617
int max_wal_size_mb
Definition xlog.c:121
const ShmemCallbacks XLOGShmemCallbacks
Definition xlog.c:590
void ShutdownXLOG(int code, Datum arg)
Definition xlog.c:7100
static bool PerformRecoveryXLogAction(void)
Definition xlog.c:6782
RecoveryState GetRecoveryState(void)
Definition xlog.c:6868
int XLogArchiveTimeout
Definition xlog.c:125
static void CleanupAfterArchiveRecovery(TimeLineID EndOfLogTLI, XLogRecPtr EndOfLog, TimeLineID newTLI)
Definition xlog.c:5707
#define ConvertToXSegs(x, segsize)
Definition xlog.c:623
bool wal_recycle
Definition xlog.c:135
static void RemoveXlogFile(const struct dirent *segment_de, XLogSegNo recycleSegNo, XLogSegNo *endlogSegNo, TimeLineID insertTLI)
Definition xlog.c:4060
pg_time_t GetLastSegSwitchData(XLogRecPtr *lastSwitchLSN)
Definition xlog.c:7083
const char * show_effective_wal_level(void)
Definition xlog.c:5243
static int XLOGChooseNumBuffers(void)
Definition xlog.c:5025
static XLogRecPtr XLogBytePosToEndRecPtr(uint64 bytepos)
Definition xlog.c:1939
static void LogCheckpointEnd(bool restartpoint, int flags)
Definition xlog.c:7187
static int get_sync_bit(int method)
Definition xlog.c:9268
static XLogwrtResult LogwrtResult
Definition xlog.c:632
void XLogSetReplicationSlotMinimumLSN(XLogRecPtr lsn)
Definition xlog.c:2687
void SwitchIntoArchiveRecovery(XLogRecPtr EndRecPtr, TimeLineID replayTLI)
Definition xlog.c:6707
static bool lastFullPageWrites
Definition xlog.c:224
char * wal_consistency_checking_string
Definition xlog.c:132
bool DataChecksumsNeedVerify(void)
Definition xlog.c:4733
static void WALInsertLockAcquire(void)
Definition xlog.c:1412
void SetDataChecksumsOn(void)
Definition xlog.c:4802
int CommitSiblings
Definition xlog.c:140
static void CopyXLogRecordToWAL(int write_len, bool isLogSwitch, XLogRecData *rdata, XLogRecPtr StartPos, XLogRecPtr EndPos, TimeLineID tli)
Definition xlog.c:1266
bool GetDefaultCharSignedness(void)
Definition xlog.c:4993
bool DataChecksumsOn(void)
Definition xlog.c:4695
static double CheckPointDistanceEstimate
Definition xlog.c:166
static uint64 XLogRecPtrToBytePos(XLogRecPtr ptr)
Definition xlog.c:1982
const char * show_in_hot_standby(void)
Definition xlog.c:5228
XLogRecPtr GetXLogInsertRecPtr(void)
Definition xlog.c:10092
void SetWalWriterSleeping(bool sleeping)
Definition xlog.c:10188
bool wal_log_hints
Definition xlog.c:130
static void XLogInitNewTimeline(TimeLineID endTLI, XLogRecPtr endOfLog, TimeLineID newTLI)
Definition xlog.c:5632
static void CheckRequiredParameterValues(void)
Definition xlog.c:5803
#define XLogRecPtrToBufIdx(recptr)
Definition xlog.c:611
int wal_sync_method
Definition xlog.c:137
void SetDataChecksumsOnInProgress(void)
Definition xlog.c:4749
int XLogFileOpen(XLogSegNo segno, TimeLineID tli)
Definition xlog.c:3669
int max_slot_wal_keep_size_mb
Definition xlog.c:142
XLogRecPtr GetFlushRecPtr(TimeLineID *insertTLI)
Definition xlog.c:6997
static void PreallocXlogFiles(XLogRecPtr endptr, TimeLineID tli)
Definition xlog.c:3741
static bool doPageWrites
Definition xlog.c:293
static bool holdingAllLocks
Definition xlog.c:687
static TimeLineID openLogTLI
Definition xlog.c:657
XLogRecPtr XactLastCommitEnd
Definition xlog.c:262
WalLevel GetActiveWalLevelOnStandby(void)
Definition xlog.c:5286
bool log_checkpoints
Definition xlog.c:136
static void KeepLogSeg(XLogRecPtr recptr, XLogSegNo *logSegNo)
Definition xlog.c:8495
static void XLogWrite(XLogwrtRqst WriteRqst, TimeLineID tli, bool flexible)
Definition xlog.c:2325
static void XLogChecksums(uint32 new_type)
Definition xlog.c:8730
void InitializeWalConsistencyChecking(void)
Definition xlog.c:5190
static void UpdateMinRecoveryPoint(XLogRecPtr lsn, bool force)
Definition xlog.c:2721
static int LocalSetXLogInsertAllowed(void)
Definition xlog.c:6920
void assign_max_wal_size(int newval, void *extra)
Definition xlog.c:2221
void RemoveNonParentXlogFiles(XLogRecPtr switchpoint, TimeLineID newTLI)
Definition xlog.c:3991
XLogRecPtr GetLastImportantRecPtr(void)
Definition xlog.c:7054
void xlog_redo(XLogReaderState *record)
Definition xlog.c:8821
static int MyLockNo
Definition xlog.c:686
static void RecoveryRestartPoint(const CheckPoint *checkPoint, XLogReaderState *record)
Definition xlog.c:8086
bool XLogNeedsFlush(XLogRecPtr record)
Definition xlog.c:3159
void register_persistent_abort_backup_handler(void)
Definition xlog.c:10078
static double PrevCheckPointDistance
Definition xlog.c:167
void ReachedEndOfBackup(XLogRecPtr EndRecPtr, TimeLineID tli)
Definition xlog.c:6745
void LocalProcessControlFile(bool reset)
Definition xlog.c:5271
static void XLOGShmemInit(void *arg)
Definition xlog.c:5349
static void XLogFileClose(void)
Definition xlog.c:3690
int wal_compression
Definition xlog.c:131
static void UpdateCheckPointDistanceEstimate(uint64 nbytes)
Definition xlog.c:7294
static bool LocalRecoveryInProgress
Definition xlog.c:231
XLogSegNo XLogGetOldestSegno(TimeLineID tli)
Definition xlog.c:3825
int data_checksums
Definition xlog.c:683
bool DataChecksumsOff(void)
Definition xlog.c:4683
XLogRecPtr GetXLogWriteRecPtr(void)
Definition xlog.c:10124
static void XLOGShmemAttach(void *arg)
Definition xlog.c:5445
void ResetInstallXLogFileSegmentActive(void)
Definition xlog.c:10165
static WALInsertLockPadded * WALInsertLocks
Definition xlog.c:578
static XLogSegNo openLogSegNo
Definition xlog.c:656
#define INSERT_FREESPACE(endptr)
Definition xlog.c:600
int wal_retrieve_retry_interval
Definition xlog.c:141
int XLOGbuffers
Definition xlog.c:124
bool XLogBackgroundFlush(void)
Definition xlog.c:3004
const struct config_enum_entry archive_mode_options[]
Definition xlog.c:198
void GetOldestRestartPoint(XLogRecPtr *oldrecptr, TimeLineID *oldtli)
Definition xlog.c:10136
char * GetMockAuthenticationNonce(void)
Definition xlog.c:4653
bool track_wal_io_timing
Definition xlog.c:144
static XLogSegNo XLOGfileslop(XLogRecPtr lastredoptr)
Definition xlog.c:2251
static int UsableBytesInSegment
Definition xlog.c:626
const char * show_data_checksums(void)
Definition xlog.c:4980
static char * GetXLogBuffer(XLogRecPtr ptr, TimeLineID tli)
Definition xlog.c:1673
bool DataChecksumsInProgressOn(void)
Definition xlog.c:4707
WalInsertClass
Definition xlog.c:569
@ WALINSERT_SPECIAL_SWITCH
Definition xlog.c:571
@ WALINSERT_NORMAL
Definition xlog.c:570
@ WALINSERT_SPECIAL_CHECKPOINT
Definition xlog.c:572
bool XLogInsertAllowed(void)
Definition xlog.c:6887
void do_pg_backup_start(const char *backupidstr, bool fast, List **tablespaces, BackupState *state, StringInfo tblspcmapfile)
Definition xlog.c:9455
static ControlFileData * ControlFile
Definition xlog.c:584
bool check_wal_segment_size(int *newval, void **extra, GucSource source)
Definition xlog.c:2235
static void XLogFileCopy(TimeLineID destTLI, XLogSegNo destsegno, TimeLineID srcTLI, XLogSegNo srcsegno, int upto)
Definition xlog.c:3469
static int LocalXLogInsertAllowed
Definition xlog.c:243
static void RemoveTempXlogFiles(void)
Definition xlog.c:3883
XLogRecPtr XLogRestorePoint(const char *rpName)
Definition xlog.c:8622
static XLogRecPtr LocalMinRecoveryPoint
Definition xlog.c:666
#define NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS
Definition xlog.c:157
TimeLineID GetWALInsertionTimeLineIfSet(void)
Definition xlog.c:7034
void do_pg_backup_stop(BackupState *state, bool waitforarchive)
Definition xlog.c:9777
bool check_wal_consistency_checking(char **newval, void **extra, GucSource source)
Definition xlog.c:5076
const struct config_enum_entry wal_sync_method_options[]
Definition xlog.c:178
int min_wal_size_mb
Definition xlog.c:122
bool CreateCheckPoint(int flags)
Definition xlog.c:7397
#define BootstrapTimeLineID
Definition xlog.c:118
bool DataChecksumsNeedWrite(void)
Definition xlog.c:4674
CheckpointStatsData CheckpointStats
Definition xlog.c:216
bool check_wal_buffers(int *newval, void **extra, GucSource source)
Definition xlog.c:5041
XLogRecPtr GetFakeLSNForUnloggedRel(void)
Definition xlog.c:5008
static char * str_time(pg_time_t tnow, char *buf, size_t bufsize)
Definition xlog.c:5619
XLogRecPtr GetXLogInsertEndRecPtr(void)
Definition xlog.c:10108
void XLogPutNextOid(Oid nextOid)
Definition xlog.c:8567
static ChecksumStateType LocalDataChecksumState
Definition xlog.c:677
void XLogFlush(XLogRecPtr record)
Definition xlog.c:2801
static void ReadControlFile(void)
Definition xlog.c:4406
static SessionBackupState sessionBackupState
Definition xlog.c:398
XLogRecPtr XLogAssignLSN(void)
Definition xlog.c:8652
void InitLocalDataChecksumState(void)
Definition xlog.c:4962
static void CheckPointGuts(XLogRecPtr checkPointRedo, int flags)
Definition xlog.c:8046
static bool updateMinRecoveryPoint
Definition xlog.c:668
static void XLOGShmemRequest(void *arg)
Definition xlog.c:5295
int CheckPointSegments
Definition xlog.c:163
static bool check_wal_consistency_checking_deferred
Definition xlog.c:173
static void ReserveXLogInsertLocation(int size, XLogRecPtr *StartPos, XLogRecPtr *EndPos, XLogRecPtr *PrevPtr)
Definition xlog.c:1149
void XLogShutdownWalRcv(void)
Definition xlog.c:10146
#define NextBufIdx(idx)
Definition xlog.c:604
static void UpdateLastRemovedPtr(char *filename)
Definition xlog.c:3863
static TimeLineID LocalMinRecoveryPointTLI
Definition xlog.c:667
void issue_xlog_fsync(int fd, XLogSegNo segno, TimeLineID tli)
Definition xlog.c:9358
static bool ReserveXLogSwitch(XLogRecPtr *StartPos, XLogRecPtr *EndPos, XLogRecPtr *PrevPtr)
Definition xlog.c:1205
void XLogSetAsyncXactLSN(XLogRecPtr asyncXactLSN)
Definition xlog.c:2630
bool XLogCheckpointNeeded(XLogSegNo new_segno)
Definition xlog.c:2301
bool * wal_consistency_checking
Definition xlog.c:133
static int XLogFileInitInternal(XLogSegNo logsegno, TimeLineID logtli, bool *added, char *path)
Definition xlog.c:3243
static void update_checkpoint_display(int flags, bool restartpoint, bool reset)
Definition xlog.c:7332
#define XLogArchivingActive()
Definition xlog.h:102
#define TABLESPACE_MAP_OLD
Definition xlog.h:338
#define XLOG_MARK_UNIMPORTANT
Definition xlog.h:167
#define TABLESPACE_MAP
Definition xlog.h:337
@ ARCHIVE_MODE_ALWAYS
Definition xlog.h:69
@ ARCHIVE_MODE_OFF
Definition xlog.h:67
@ ARCHIVE_MODE_ON
Definition xlog.h:68
#define CHECKPOINT_FLUSH_UNLOGGED
Definition xlog.h:155
#define XLogLogicalInfoActive()
Definition xlog.h:137
#define STANDBY_SIGNAL_FILE
Definition xlog.h:333
#define CHECKPOINT_CAUSE_XLOG
Definition xlog.h:160
WALAvailability
Definition xlog.h:200
@ WALAVAIL_REMOVED
Definition xlog.h:206
@ WALAVAIL_RESERVED
Definition xlog.h:202
@ WALAVAIL_UNRESERVED
Definition xlog.h:205
@ WALAVAIL_EXTENDED
Definition xlog.h:203
@ WALAVAIL_INVALID_LSN
Definition xlog.h:201
#define BACKUP_LABEL_OLD
Definition xlog.h:335
#define CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY
Definition xlog.h:152
@ WAL_COMPRESSION_NONE
Definition xlog.h:84
#define BACKUP_LABEL_FILE
Definition xlog.h:334
#define CHECKPOINT_CAUSE_TIME
Definition xlog.h:161
#define CHECKPOINT_FORCE
Definition xlog.h:154
SessionBackupState
Definition xlog.h:318
@ SESSION_BACKUP_RUNNING
Definition xlog.h:320
@ SESSION_BACKUP_NONE
Definition xlog.h:319
#define CHECKPOINT_WAIT
Definition xlog.h:157
#define CHECKPOINT_FAST
Definition xlog.h:153
#define RECOVERY_SIGNAL_FILE
Definition xlog.h:332
#define CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN
Definition xlog.h:151
#define XLogArchivingAlways()
Definition xlog.h:105
WalLevel
Definition xlog.h:75
@ WAL_LEVEL_REPLICA
Definition xlog.h:77
@ WAL_LEVEL_LOGICAL
Definition xlog.h:78
@ WAL_LEVEL_MINIMAL
Definition xlog.h:76
RecoveryState
Definition xlog.h:92
@ RECOVERY_STATE_CRASH
Definition xlog.h:93
@ RECOVERY_STATE_DONE
Definition xlog.h:95
@ RECOVERY_STATE_ARCHIVE
Definition xlog.h:94
#define XLogIsNeeded()
Definition xlog.h:112
@ WAL_SYNC_METHOD_OPEN
Definition xlog.h:27
@ WAL_SYNC_METHOD_FDATASYNC
Definition xlog.h:26
@ WAL_SYNC_METHOD_FSYNC_WRITETHROUGH
Definition xlog.h:28
@ WAL_SYNC_METHOD_OPEN_DSYNC
Definition xlog.h:29
@ WAL_SYNC_METHOD_FSYNC
Definition xlog.h:25
#define XLogStandbyInfoActive()
Definition xlog.h:126
#define XLP_FIRST_IS_CONTRECORD
static RmgrData GetRmgr(RmgrId rmid)
#define IsValidWalSegSize(size)
XLogLongPageHeaderData * XLogLongPageHeader
#define XLP_FIRST_IS_OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD
#define XLOG_CONTROL_FILE
#define XLogSegmentOffset(xlogptr, wal_segsz_bytes)
static bool IsXLogFileName(const char *fname)
static void XLogFromFileName(const char *fname, TimeLineID *tli, XLogSegNo *logSegNo, int wal_segsz_bytes)
#define XLByteToPrevSeg(xlrp, logSegNo, wal_segsz_bytes)
#define XLogSegNoOffsetToRecPtr(segno, offset, wal_segsz_bytes, dest)
#define MAXFNAMELEN
XLogPageHeaderData * XLogPageHeader
#define XLOGDIR
#define XLP_LONG_HEADER
static bool IsBackupHistoryFileName(const char *fname)
#define XLOG_PAGE_MAGIC
#define XLByteToSeg(xlrp, logSegNo, wal_segsz_bytes)
static void BackupHistoryFileName(char *fname, TimeLineID tli, XLogSegNo logSegNo, XLogRecPtr startpoint, int wal_segsz_bytes)
static void XLogFilePath(char *path, TimeLineID tli, XLogSegNo logSegNo, int wal_segsz_bytes)
#define XRecOffIsValid(xlrp)
#define SizeOfXLogShortPHD
#define SizeOfXLogLongPHD
static void XLogFileName(char *fname, TimeLineID tli, XLogSegNo logSegNo, int wal_segsz_bytes)
static void BackupHistoryFilePath(char *path, TimeLineID tli, XLogSegNo logSegNo, XLogRecPtr startpoint, int wal_segsz_bytes)
static bool RmgrIdExists(RmgrId rmid)
#define XLByteInPrevSeg(xlrp, logSegNo, wal_segsz_bytes)
static bool IsPartialXLogFileName(const char *fname)
bool XLogArchiveIsReadyOrDone(const char *xlog)
bool XLogArchiveIsBusy(const char *xlog)
bool XLogArchiveIsReady(const char *xlog)
void XLogArchiveNotifySeg(XLogSegNo segno, TimeLineID tli)
void ExecuteRecoveryCommand(const char *command, const char *commandName, bool failOnSignal, uint32 wait_event_info)
bool XLogArchiveCheckDone(const char *xlog)
void XLogArchiveNotify(const char *xlog)
void XLogArchiveCleanup(const char *xlog)
char * build_backup_content(BackupState *state, bool ishistoryfile)
Definition xlogbackup.c:29
#define XLogRecPtrIsValid(r)
Definition xlogdefs.h:29
#define LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(lsn)
Definition xlogdefs.h:47
#define FirstNormalUnloggedLSN
Definition xlogdefs.h:37
uint64 XLogRecPtr
Definition xlogdefs.h:21
#define InvalidXLogRecPtr
Definition xlogdefs.h:28
uint32 TimeLineID
Definition xlogdefs.h:63
#define DEFAULT_WAL_SYNC_METHOD
Definition xlogdefs.h:83
uint64 XLogSegNo
Definition xlogdefs.h:52
const char * get_checksum_state_string(uint32 state)
Definition xlogdesc.c:59
XLogRecPtr XLogInsert(RmgrId rmid, uint8 info)
Definition xloginsert.c:482
void XLogRegisterData(const void *data, uint32 len)
Definition xloginsert.c:372
void XLogSetRecordFlags(uint8 flags)
Definition xloginsert.c:464
void XLogBeginInsert(void)
Definition xloginsert.c:153
XLogReaderState * XLogReaderAllocate(int wal_segment_size, const char *waldir, XLogReaderRoutine *routine, void *private_data)
Definition xlogreader.c:108
bool DecodeXLogRecord(XLogReaderState *state, DecodedXLogRecord *decoded, XLogRecord *record, XLogRecPtr lsn, char **errormsg)
size_t DecodeXLogRecordRequiredSpace(size_t xl_tot_len)
#define XLogRecGetInfo(decoder)
Definition xlogreader.h:410
#define XLogRecGetData(decoder)
Definition xlogreader.h:415
#define XL_ROUTINE(...)
Definition xlogreader.h:117
#define XLogRecMaxBlockId(decoder)
Definition xlogreader.h:418
#define XLogRecHasBlockImage(decoder, block_id)
Definition xlogreader.h:423
#define XLogRecHasAnyBlockRefs(decoder)
Definition xlogreader.h:417
#define SizeOfXLogRecordDataHeaderShort
Definition xlogrecord.h:217
#define XLR_BLOCK_ID_DATA_SHORT
Definition xlogrecord.h:241
#define SizeOfXLogRecord
Definition xlogrecord.h:55
void ShutdownWalRecovery(void)
bool ArchiveRecoveryRequested
bool InArchiveRecovery
void RecoveryRequiresIntParameter(const char *param_name, int currValue, int minValue)
void PerformWalRecovery(void)
char * archiveCleanupCommand
XLogRecPtr GetCurrentReplayRecPtr(TimeLineID *replayEndTLI)
void xlog_outdesc(StringInfo buf, XLogReaderState *record)
bool PromoteIsTriggered(void)
static XLogRecPtr missingContrecPtr
XLogRecPtr GetXLogReplayRecPtr(TimeLineID *replayTLI)
static XLogRecPtr abortedRecPtr
EndOfWalRecoveryInfo * FinishWalRecovery(void)
void InitWalRecovery(ControlFileData *ControlFile, bool *wasShutdown_ptr, bool *haveBackupLabel_ptr, bool *haveTblspcMap_ptr)
char * recoveryEndCommand
TimeLineID recoveryTargetTLI
TimestampTz GetLatestXTime(void)
bool XLogHaveInvalidPages(void)
Definition xlogutils.c:224
XLogRedoAction XLogReadBufferForRedo(XLogReaderState *record, uint8 block_id, Buffer *buf)
Definition xlogutils.c:303
HotStandbyState standbyState
Definition xlogutils.c:53
bool InRecovery
Definition xlogutils.c:50
@ STANDBY_DISABLED
Definition xlogutils.h:52
@ STANDBY_INITIALIZED
Definition xlogutils.h:53
#define InHotStandby
Definition xlogutils.h:60
@ BLK_RESTORED
Definition xlogutils.h:76
void WaitLSNWakeup(WaitLSNType lsnType, XLogRecPtr currentLSN)
Definition xlogwait.c:344
@ WAIT_LSN_TYPE_PRIMARY_FLUSH
Definition xlogwait.h:44
@ WAIT_LSN_TYPE_STANDBY_REPLAY
Definition xlogwait.h:39
@ WAIT_LSN_TYPE_STANDBY_FLUSH
Definition xlogwait.h:41
@ WAIT_LSN_TYPE_STANDBY_WRITE
Definition xlogwait.h:40